blob: b4dc1adf51f976216d9419f37a20b4b103164ee3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubfd19d62021-04-23 19:11:10 +02007 2021/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200897 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200898 - description
899 - deviceatlas-json-file
900 - deviceatlas-log-level
901 - deviceatlas-separator
902 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900903 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904 - gid
905 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100906 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200907 - h1-case-adjust
908 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100909 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100910 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100911 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200912 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200914 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100915 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200916 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100917 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100918 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200919 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200921 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200922 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100923 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200925 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100926 - presetenv
927 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200928 - uid
929 - ulimit-n
930 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200931 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100932 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100933 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200934 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200937 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200938 - ssl-default-bind-options
939 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200940 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200941 - ssl-default-server-options
942 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100943 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200944 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100945 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100946 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100947 - 51degrees-data-file
948 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200949 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200950 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200951 - wurfl-data-file
952 - wurfl-information-list
953 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200954 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100955 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100956
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100958 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200959 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200960 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200961 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100962 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100963 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100964 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200965 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200966 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200967 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200968 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - noepoll
970 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000971 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100973 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300974 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000975 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100976 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200977 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200978 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200979 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000980 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000981 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200982 - tune.buffers.limit
983 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200984 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200985 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100986 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200987 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200988 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200989 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200990 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100991 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200992 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200993 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200994 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100995 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100996 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100997 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100998 - tune.lua.session-timeout
999 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001000 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001001 - tune.maxaccept
1002 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001003 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001004 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001005 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001006 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1007 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001008 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1009 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001010 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001011 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001012 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001013 - tune.sndbuf.client
1014 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001015 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001016 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001018 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001020 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001021 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001022 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001023 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001024 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001025 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1026 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1027 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001028 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1029 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001030
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001033 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034
1035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010363.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001037------------------------------------
1038
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001039ca-base <dir>
1040 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001041 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1042 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1043 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001045chroot <jail dir>
1046 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1047 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1048 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1049 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1050 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001051 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001052
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001053cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1054 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1055 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1056 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1057 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1058 set. These sets have the format
1059
1060 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1061
1062 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001063 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001064 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1065 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001066 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1067 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001068 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1069 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1070 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1071 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1072 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1073 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1074 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1075 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1076 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1077 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001078
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001079 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1080 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1081 on the machine's word size.
1082
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001083 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001084 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1085 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1086 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1087 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1088 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1089 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001090
1091 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001092 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1093
1094 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1095 # first 4 CPUs
1096
1097 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1098 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1099 # word size.
1100
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001101 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001102 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001103 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1104 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1105 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1106
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001107 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1108 # and so on.
1109 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1110 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1111 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001113 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001114 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1115 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1116 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1117
1118 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1119 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1120 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1121
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001122 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1123 # and a thread range.
1124 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1125 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1126 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1127
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001128crt-base <dir>
1129 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001130 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1131 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133daemon
1134 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1135 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001136 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1137 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001139default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1140 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1141 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1142 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1143 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1144 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1145 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1146 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1147 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1148 not start with a slash ('/'):
1149 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1150 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1151
1152 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1153 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1154 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1155 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1156 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1157 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1158 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1159 each of them.
1160
1161 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1162 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1163 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1164 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1165 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1166 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1167 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1168 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1169
1170 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1171 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1172 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1173 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1174 made easily relocatable.
1175
1176 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1177 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1178 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1179 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1180 consistent across all configuration files.
1181
1182 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1183 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1184 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1185 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1186 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1187 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1188 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1189 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1190
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001191deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1192 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001193 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001194
1195deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001196 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001197 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1198
1199deviceatlas-separator <char>
1200 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1201 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1202
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001203deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001204 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1205 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1206 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001207
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001208external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001209 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1210 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001211 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1212 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1213 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1214 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1215 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001216
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001218 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1220 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001221 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1222 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001223 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001224
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001225group <group name>
1226 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1227 See also "gid" and "user".
1228
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001229hard-stop-after <time>
1230 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1231
1232 Arguments :
1233 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1234 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1235 SIGUSR1 signal.
1236
1237 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1238 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1239 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1240
1241 Example:
1242 global
1243 hard-stop-after 30s
1244
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001245h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1246 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1247 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1248 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1249 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001250 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001251 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1252 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1253 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1254 specified in a proxy.
1255
1256 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1257 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1258 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1259 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1260 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1261 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1262 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1263
1264 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1265 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1266 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1267 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1268 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1269
1270 Example:
1271 global
1272 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1273
1274 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1275 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1276
1277h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1278 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1279 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1280 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1281 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1282 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1283 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1284 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1285 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1286
1287 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1288 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1289 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1290
1291 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1292 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1293
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001294insecure-fork-wanted
1295 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1296 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1297 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1298 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1299 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1300 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1301 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1302 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1303 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1304 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1305 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1306 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1307 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1308 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1309 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1310 disable it.
1311
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001312insecure-setuid-wanted
1313 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1314 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1315 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1316 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1317 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1318 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1319 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1320 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1321 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1322 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1323 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1324 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1325 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1326 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1327
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001328issuers-chain-path <dir>
1329 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1330 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1331 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1332 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1333 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1334 "issuers-chain-path".
1335 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1336 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1337 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1338 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1339 will share the chain in memory.
1340
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001341localpeer <name>
1342 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1343 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1344 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1345 the configuration parsing.
1346
1347 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1348 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1349
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001350log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001351 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001352 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001354 configured with "log global".
1355
1356 <address> can be one of:
1357
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001358 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001359 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1360 port).
1361
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001362 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1363 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1364 port).
1365
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001366 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001367 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1368 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001369 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001370
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001371 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1372 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1373 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1374 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1375 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1376 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1377 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1378 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1379 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1380 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1381 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1382 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1383 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1384 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001385 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1386 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001387
1388 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1389 "fd@2", see above.
1390
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001391 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1392 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1393 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1394 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1395 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1396
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001397 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1398 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001399
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001400 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1401 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1402 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1403 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1404 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1405 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1406 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1407 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1408 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1409 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001410 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1411 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001412
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001413 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1414 one of the following :
1415
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001416 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1417 field is stripped. This is the default.
1418 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1419 rfc3164.
1420
1421 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001422 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1423
1424 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1425 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1426
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001427 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1428 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1429 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1430 designed to be used with a local log server.
1431
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001432 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1433 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1434 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1435 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1436 logger consumes.
1437
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001438 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1439 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1440 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1441 used with a local log server.
1442
1443 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1444 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1445 designed to be used with a local log server.
1446
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001447 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1448 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1449 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1450 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1451
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001452 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1453 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1454 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1455 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1456 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1457
1458 <sample_size>
1459 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1460 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1461 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1462 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1463 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1464
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001465 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001466
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001467 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1468 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1469 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1470
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001471 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1472 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1473 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1474 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
1476 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001477 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1478 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1479 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1480 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1481 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1482 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001483
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001484 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001485
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001486log-send-hostname [<string>]
1487 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1488 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1489 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1490 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1491 the logs.
1492
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001493log-tag <string>
1494 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1495 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1496 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001497 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001498
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001499lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001500 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1501 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1502 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1503 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1504 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1505 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001506 used multiple times.
1507
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001508lua-load-per-thread <file>
1509 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1510 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1511 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1512 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1513 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1514 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1515 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1516 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1517 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1518 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1519 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1520 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1521 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1522 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1523 times.
1524
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001525lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1526 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1527 variable.
1528 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1529 to "path".
1530
1531 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1532 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1533 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1534 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1535 will be checked earlier.
1536
1537 As an example by specifying the following path:
1538
1539 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1540 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1541
1542 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1543 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1544 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1545 paths if that does not exist either.
1546
1547 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1548 documentation.
1549
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001550master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001551 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1552 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1553 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001554 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001555 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1556 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001557 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1558 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1559 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1560 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1561 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001562
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001563 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001564
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001565mworker-max-reloads <number>
1566 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001567 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001568 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1569 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1570 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1571
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001572nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001573 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1574 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1575 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001576 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1577 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001578 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1579 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1580 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001582nbthread <number>
1583 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001584 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1585 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1586 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1587 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1588 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001589 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1590 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1591 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1592 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1593 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1594 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1595 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001596
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001597numa-cpu-mapping
1598 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1599 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1600 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1601 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1602 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1603 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1604 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1605 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1606 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001609 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1610 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1611 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1612 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001613
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001614pp2-never-send-local
1615 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1616 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1617 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1618 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1619 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1620 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1621 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1622 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1623 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1624 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1625 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1626
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001627presetenv <name> <value>
1628 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1629 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1630 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1631 and "unsetenv".
1632
1633resetenv [<name> ...]
1634 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1635 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1636 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1637 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1638 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1639 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1640 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1641 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1642
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001643stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001644 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1645 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1646 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1647 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1648 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1649 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001650 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001651 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1652 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1653 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1654 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001655
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001656server-state-base <directory>
1657 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001658 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1659 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001660
1661server-state-file <file>
1662 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1663 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1664 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1665 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1666 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1667 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1668 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1669 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001670 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1671 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001672
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001673set-var <var-name> <expr>
1674 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1675 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1676 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1677 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1678 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1679 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1680 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1681 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1682 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1683
1684 Example:
1685 global
1686 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1687 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1688 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1689
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001690setenv <name> <value>
1691 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1692 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1693 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1694 and "unsetenv".
1695
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001696set-dumpable
1697 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001698 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1699 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1700 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1701 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1702 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1703 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1704 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1705 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1706 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1707 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1708 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1709 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1710 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1711 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1712 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1713 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1714 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001715
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001716ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1718 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001719 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001720 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001721 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1722 information and recommendations see e.g.
1723 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1724 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1725 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1726 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001727
1728ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1730 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1731 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1732 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1733 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001734 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1735 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1736 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001737 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001738
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001739ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1741 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1742 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1743 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1744 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1745
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001746ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1748 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1749 keyword to see available options.
1750
1751 Example:
1752 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001753 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001754
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001755ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1757 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001758 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001759 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001760 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1761 information and recommendations see e.g.
1762 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1763 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1764 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1765 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1766 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001767
1768ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1770 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1771 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1772 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1773 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001774 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1775 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1776 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1777 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001778
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001779ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1781 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1782 keyword to see available options.
1783
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001784ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1786 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1787 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001789 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001790 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1791 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1792 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1793 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001794 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1795 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1796 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1797
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001798ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1799 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1800 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001801 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001802 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001803 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1804
1805 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001806
1807 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1808 and won't try to remove them.
1809
1810 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1811
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001812ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001813 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001814 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1815 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001816
1817 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1818 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1819 optimize the startup time.
1820
1821 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1822 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1823 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1824
1825 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001826 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001827
1828 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001829 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1830
1831 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1832 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1833 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1834 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1835 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1836 bind configuration..
1837
1838 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1839 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1840 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1841 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1842 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1843 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1844 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1845 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1846
1847 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1848
1849 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1850 a cert bundle.
1851
1852 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1853 separately in several "crt".
1854
1855 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1856 since files are loading separately.
1857
1858 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1859 required to commit them.
1860
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001861 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001862 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001863
1864 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1865
1866 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1867
1868 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1869 not provided in the PEM file.
1870
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001871 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1872 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1873
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001874 The default behavior is "all".
1875
1876 Example:
1877 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1878 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1879 ssl-load-extra-files none
1880
1881 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1882
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001883ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1884 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1885 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1886 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1887
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001888ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001889 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001890 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1891 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1892 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1893 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1894 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1895 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001896 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001897
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001898stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1899 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1900 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1901 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001902 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001903 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001904
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001905 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1906 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1907 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001908
1909stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1910 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1911 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001912 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001913
1914stats maxconn <connections>
1915 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1916 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001919 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001920 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1921 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1922 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1923
1924ulimit-n <number>
1925 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1926 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1927 option.
1928
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001929unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1930 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1931
1932 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1933 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1934 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1935 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1936 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1937 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1938 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1939 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1940 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1941 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1942
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001943unsetenv [<name> ...]
1944 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1945 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1946 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1947 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1948 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1949 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1950 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001952user <user name>
1953 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1954 See also "uid" and "group".
1955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001956node <name>
1957 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1958
1959 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1960 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1961 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1962 traffic.
1963
1964description <text>
1965 Add a text that describes the instance.
1966
1967 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1968 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1969 "<" and ">" characters.
1970
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100197151degrees-data-file <file path>
1972 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1977
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000197851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001979 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1980 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1981 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1982
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001983 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001984 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1985
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200198651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001987 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1988 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1989
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1992
199351degrees-cache-size <number>
1994 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1995 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1996 By default, this cache is disabled.
1997
1998 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001999 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2000
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002001wurfl-data-file <file path>
2002 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2003 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2004
2005 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2006 with USE_WURFL=1.
2007
2008wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2009 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2010 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2011 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2012
2013 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2014
2015 Valid WURFL properties are:
2016 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2017
2018 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2019 device.
2020
2021 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2022 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2023
2024 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2025 particular web request.
2026
2027 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2028 used Libwurfl API version.
2029
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002030 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2031 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2032
2033 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2034 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2035
2036 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2037
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002038 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2039 with USE_WURFL=1.
2040
2041wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2042 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2043 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2044
2045 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2046 with USE_WURFL=1.
2047
2048wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2049 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2050 thus before the chroot.
2051
2052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2053 with USE_WURFL=1.
2054
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002055wurfl-cache-size <size>
2056 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2057 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002058 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002059 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002060
2061 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2062 with USE_WURFL=1.
2063
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002064strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002065 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2066 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2067 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2068 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2069 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072-----------------------
2073
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002074busy-polling
2075 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2076 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2077 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2078 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2079 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2080 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2081 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2082 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2083 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2084 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2085 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2086 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2087 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2088 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2089 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2090 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2091 "poll" pollers.
2092
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002093 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2094 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2095 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2096
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002097max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2098 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2099 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2100 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2101 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2102 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2103 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2104 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2105 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107maxconn <number>
2108 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2109 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2110 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002111 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2112 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2113 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2114 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002115 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2116 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2117 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2118 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2119 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2120 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002121
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002122maxconnrate <number>
2123 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2124 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2125 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2126 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2127 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2128 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2129 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2130 fairness.
2131
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002132maxcomprate <number>
2133 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002134 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002135 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2136 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2137 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002138 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002139 default value.
2140
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002141maxcompcpuusage <number>
2142 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2143 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2144 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2145 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2146 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2147 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2148 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2149 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2150
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002151maxpipes <number>
2152 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2153 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2154 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2155 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2156 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2157 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2158
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002159maxsessrate <number>
2160 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2161 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2162 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2163 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2164 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2165 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2166 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2167 fairness.
2168
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002169maxsslconn <number>
2170 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2171 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2172 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2173 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2174 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2175 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2176 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002177 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2178 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2179 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2180 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2181 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2182 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2183 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002184
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002185maxsslrate <number>
2186 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2187 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2188 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2189 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2190 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2191 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2192 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2193 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2194 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2195 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2196
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002197maxzlibmem <number>
2198 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2199 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2200 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002201 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2202 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2203 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2204
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002205noepoll
2206 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2207 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002208 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002209
2210nokqueue
2211 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2212 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2213 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2214
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002215noevports
2216 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2217 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2218 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2219 also "nopoll".
2220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221nopoll
2222 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2223 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002225 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2226 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002228nosplice
2229 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002231 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002232 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002233 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2234 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2235 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2236 "option splice-response".
2237
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002238nogetaddrinfo
2239 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2240 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2241
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002242noreuseport
2243 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2244 command line argument "-dR".
2245
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002246profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2247 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2248 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2249 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2250 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002251 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002252 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2253 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2254 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2255 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2256
2257 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2258 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2259 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2260 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2261 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002262 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2263 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2264 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2265 CLI.
2266
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002267spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002268 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2269 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2270 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2271 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2272 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2273 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002275ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002276 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002277 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002278 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2279 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2280 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2281 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2282 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002283 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2284 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002285 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2286 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2287 openssl configuration file uses:
2288 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2289
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002290ssl-mode-async
2291 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002292 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002293 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2294 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2295 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002296 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002297 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002298
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002299tune.buffers.limit <number>
2300 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2301 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2302 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2303 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2304 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002305 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002306 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2307 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2308 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2309 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2310 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2311 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2312 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2313 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2314 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2315
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002316tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2317 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2318 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2319 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2320 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2321
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002322tune.bufsize <number>
2323 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2324 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2325 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2326 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2327 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2328 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2329 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002330 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2331 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2332 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002333 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002334 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2335 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2336 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002337
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002338tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2339 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002340
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002341tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2342 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2343 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2344 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2345 this value. The default value is 1.
2346
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002347tune.fail-alloc
2348 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2349 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2350 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2351 gracefully.
2352
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002353tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2354 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2355 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2356 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2357 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2358 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2359
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002360tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2361 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2362 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2363 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2364 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2365 change it.
2366
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002367tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2368 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002369 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2370 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002371 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2372 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2373 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2374 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2375 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2376
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002377tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2378 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2379 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2380 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2381 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2382 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2383 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2384 recommended not to change this value.
2385
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002386tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2387 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2388 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2389 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2390 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2391 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2392 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2393 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2394
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002395tune.http.cookielen <number>
2396 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2397 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2398 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2399 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2400 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2401 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2402 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2403 to change this value.
2404
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002405tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002406 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2407 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002408 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002409 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002410 configuration directives too.
2411 The default value is 1024.
2412
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002413tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2414 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2415 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2416 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2417 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2418 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2419 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002420 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2421 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2422 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002423
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002424tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2425 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2426 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2427 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2428 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2429 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2430 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002431 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2432 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2433 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2434 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2435 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002436
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002437tune.idletimer <timeout>
2438 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2439 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2440 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2441 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2442 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2443 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002444 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002445 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002446 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2447
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002448tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2449 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2450 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2451 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2452 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2453 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2454 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2455 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2456 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2457 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2458
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002459tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2460 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002461 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002462 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2463 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002464 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002465 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2466 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2467
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002468tune.lua.maxmem
2469 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2470 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2471 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2472 memory.
2473
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002474tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2475 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002476 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2477 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002478 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002479
2480tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2481 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2482 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2483 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2484 check servers.
2485
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002486tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2487 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2488 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2489 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002490 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002491
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002492tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002493 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2494 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002495 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2496 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2497 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2498 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2499 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2500 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2501 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2502 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2503 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002504
2505tune.maxpollevents <number>
2506 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2507 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2508 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2509 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2510 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2511
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002512tune.maxrewrite <number>
2513 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2514 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2515 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2516 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2517 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2518 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2519 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2520 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2521 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2522 bufsize.
2523
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002524tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2525 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2526 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2527 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2528 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2529 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2530 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2531 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2532 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2533 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002534 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2535 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002536 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2537 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2538 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2539 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2540 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2541 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2542 setting this parameter to 0.
2543
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002544tune.pipesize <number>
2545 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2546 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2547 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2548 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2549 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2550 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2551
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002552tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2553 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2554 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2555 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2556 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2557 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2558 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002559 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002560
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002561tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2562 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2563 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2564 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2565 default is 20.
2566
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002567tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2568tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2569 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2570 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2571 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002572 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002573 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002574 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2575 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2576
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002577tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002578 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002579 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2580 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2581 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2582 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2583
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002584tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002585 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002586 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2587 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2588 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2589 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2590 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2591 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2592 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002593
2594tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2595 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2596 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2597 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2598 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2599 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2600 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2601 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2602 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2603 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002604
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002605tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2606tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2607 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2608 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2609 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002610 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002611 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002612 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2613 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2614 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2615 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2616 notifying haproxy again.
2617
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002618tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002619 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002620 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2621 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2622 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2623 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2624 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2625 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2626 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2627 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2628 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2629 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2630 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002631
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002632tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002633 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002634 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2635 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2636 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2637 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2638 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2639
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002640tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2641 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2642 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2643 performances. This is disabled by default.
2644
2645 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2646 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2647
2648 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2649
2650 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2651
2652 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2653
2654 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2655 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2656 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2657
2658 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2659 converted.
2660
2661 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2662 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2663 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2664 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2665 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2666 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2667 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002668 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2669 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002670
2671 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2672
2673 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2674 only need this line:
2675
2676 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2677
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002678tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2679 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002680 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002681 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2682 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2683 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2684 being used for too long.
2685
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002686tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2687 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2688 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2689 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2690 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2691 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2692 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2693 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2694 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2695 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2696 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002697 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002698 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002699
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002700tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2701 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2702 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2703 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2704 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002705 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002706 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2707 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002708 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2709 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002710
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002711tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2712 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2713 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2714 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2715 1000 entries.
2716
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002717tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2718 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2719 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2720 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2721
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002722tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002723tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002724tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2725tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2726tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002727 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2728 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2729 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2730 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2731 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2732 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2733 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2734 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002735
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002736 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2737 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2738 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2739 all available space is consumed.
2740 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2741 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2742 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002743
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002744tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2745 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002746 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002747 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002748 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002749 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2750
2751tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2752 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2753 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002754 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2755 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027573.3. Debugging
2758--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002760quiet
2761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2762 line argument "-q".
2763
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002764zero-warning
2765 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2766 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2767 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2768 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2769 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2770 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2771
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027733.4. Userlists
2774--------------
2775It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2776http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2777it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2778
2779userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002780 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002781 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2782
2783group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002784 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002785 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2786 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2787
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002788user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2789 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002790 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2791 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002792 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2793 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2794 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2795 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002796
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002797 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2798 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2799 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2800 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2801 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2802 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2803 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2804 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2805 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002806
2807 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002808 userlist L1
2809 group G1 users tiger,scott
2810 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002811
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002812 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2813 user scott insecure-password elgato
2814 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002815
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002816 userlist L2
2817 group G1
2818 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002819
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002820 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2821 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2822 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002823
2824 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002825
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002826
28273.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002828----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002829It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2830several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2831instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2832values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2833automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2834In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2835using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2836tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2837reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2838Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2839that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2840each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002841
2842peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2845
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002846bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2847 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2848 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2849
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002850disabled
2851 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2852 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2853 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2854
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002855default-bind [param*]
2856 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2857
2858default-server [param*]
2859 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2860
2861 Arguments:
2862 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2863 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2864 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2865 details.
2866
2867
2868 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2869
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002870enable
2871 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2872
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002873log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002874 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2875 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2876 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2877 more details.
2878
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002879peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002880 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2881 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002882 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2883 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2884 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2885 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2886 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002887
2888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2890
2891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2893 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2894 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002895
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002896 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2897 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002898
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002899 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2900 "server" keyword explanation below).
2901
2902server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002903 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002904 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2905 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2906 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2907 of this "peers" section).
2908 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2909
2910
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002911 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002912 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002913 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002914 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2915 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2916 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002917
2918 backend mybackend
2919 mode tcp
2920 balance roundrobin
2921 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2922 stick on src
2923
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002924 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2925 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002926
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002927 Example:
2928 peers mypeers
2929 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2930 default-server ssl verify none
2931 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2932 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002933
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002934
2935table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2936 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2937
2938 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2939 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002940 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002941 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2942 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2943 "stick-table" keyword).
2944
2945 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2946 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2947 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2948 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2949 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2950 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2951 of the stick-table name as follows:
2952
2953 peers mypeers
2954 peer A ...
2955 peer B ...
2956 table t1 ...
2957
2958 frontend fe1
2959 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2960
2961 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2962 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2963
2964 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2965 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2966 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2967 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2968 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2969 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2970 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2971
2972 peers mypeers
2973 peer A ...
2974 peer B ...
2975 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2976
2977 backend t1
2978 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2979
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002980 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002981 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2982 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2983
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029843.6. Mailers
2985------------
2986It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2987If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2988in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2989
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002990mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002991 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2992 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2993
2994mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2995 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2996
2997 Example:
2998 mailers mymailers
2999 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3000 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3001
3002 backend mybackend
3003 mode tcp
3004 balance roundrobin
3005
3006 email-alert mailers mymailers
3007 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3008 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3009
3010 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3011 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3012
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003013timeout mail <time>
3014 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3015 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3016 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3017 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3018
3019 Example:
3020 mailers mymailers
3021 timeout mail 20s
3022 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003023
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020030243.7. Programs
3025-------------
3026In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3027master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3028managed the same way as the workers.
3029
3030During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3031sequence as a worker:
3032
3033 - the master is re-executed
3034 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3035 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3036 instance of the program
3037
3038During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3039
3040program <name>
3041 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3042 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3043 the management guide).
3044
3045command <command> [arguments*]
3046 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3047 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3048 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3049 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3050
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003051user <user name>
3052 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3053 See also "group".
3054
3055group <group name>
3056 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3057 See also "user".
3058
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003059option start-on-reload
3060no option start-on-reload
3061 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3062 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3063 program section.
3064
3065
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010030663.8. HTTP-errors
3067----------------
3068
3069It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3070imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3071several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3072
3073http-errors <name>
3074 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3075 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3076
3077errorfile <code> <file>
3078 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3079
3080 Arguments :
3081 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003082 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003083 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003084
3085 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3086 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3087 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3088 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3089 before any chroot is performed.
3090
3091 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3092
3093 Example:
3094 http-errors website-1
3095 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3096 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3097 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3098
3099 http-errors website-2
3100 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3101 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3102 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3103
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031043.9. Rings
3105----------
3106
3107It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3108servers or traces.
3109
3110ring <ringname>
3111 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3112
3113description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003114 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003115 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3116
3117format <format>
3118 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3119
3120 Arguments:
3121 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3122 one of the following :
3123
3124 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3125 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3126 designed to be used with a local log server.
3127
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003128 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3129 field is stripped. This is the default.
3130 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3131 rfc3164.
3132
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003133 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3134 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3135 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3136 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3137 is the default.
3138
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003139 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003140 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3141
3142 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3143 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3144
3145 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3146 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3147 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3148 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3149 logger consumes.
3150
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003151 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3152 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3153 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3154 with a local log server.
3155
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003156 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3157 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3158 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3159 used with a local log server.
3160
3161maxlen <length>
3162 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3163 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3164 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3165
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003166server <name> <address> [param*]
3167 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3168 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3169 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3170 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3171 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3172 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3173 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3174 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3175 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003176 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3177 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003178
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003179size <size>
3180 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3181 set to BUFSIZE.
3182
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003183timeout connect <timeout>
3184 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3185
3186 Arguments :
3187 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3188 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3189 as explained at the top of this document.
3190
3191timeout server <timeout>
3192 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3193
3194 Arguments :
3195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3197 as explained at the top of this document.
3198
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003199 Example:
3200 global
3201 log ring@myring local7
3202
3203 ring myring
3204 description "My local buffer"
3205 format rfc3164
3206 maxlen 1200
3207 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003208 timeout connect 5s
3209 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003210 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003211
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032123.10. Log forwarding
3213-------------------
3214
3215It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3216haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3217
3218log-forward <name>
3219 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3220
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003221backlog <conns>
3222 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3223 on connections accept.
3224
3225bind <addr> [param*]
3226 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003227 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3228 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3229 syslog protocol over TCP.
3230 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003231 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3232
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003233dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003234 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3235 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3236 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3237 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003238 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003239
3240log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003241log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003242 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3243 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3244 documentation.
3245 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3246 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3247 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3248 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3249 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3250
3251 Example:
3252 global
3253 log stderr format iso local7
3254
3255 ring myring
3256 description "My local buffer"
3257 format rfc5424
3258 maxlen 1200
3259 size 32764
3260 timeout connect 5s
3261 timeout server 10s
3262 # syslog tcp server
3263 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3264
3265 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003266 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3267 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003268 # all messages on stderr
3269 log global
3270 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3271 log ring@myring local0
3272 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3273 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3274 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3275 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3276 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003277
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003278maxconn <conns>
3279 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3280 10 is the default.
3281
3282timeout client <timeout>
3283 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032854. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003286----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003288Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003289 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3290 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3291 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3292 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003293
3294A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3295connections.
3296
3297A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3298to forward incoming connections.
3299
3300A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3301parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3302
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003303A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3304ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3305sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3306the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3307explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3308from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3309"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3310for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3311to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3312optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3313are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3314any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3315names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3316that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3317duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3318names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3319
3320Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3321settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3322of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3323profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3324timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3327'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3328case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3329
3330Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3331logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3332proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3333However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3334name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3335
3336Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3337and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003338bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3340modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3341arbitrary criteria.
3342
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003343In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3344a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003345the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003346
3347 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3348 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3349 between responses and new requests.
3350
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003351 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3352 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3353 client-facing connection remains open.
3354
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003355 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3356 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003357
3358The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3359frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3360following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003361weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003362
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003363 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003364
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003365 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3366 ----+-----+-----+----
3367 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3368 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003369 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3370 ----+-----+-----+----
3371 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003372
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003373It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3374only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3375into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3376as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3377content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3378and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3379possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003381There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3382first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3383processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3384second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3385protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3386is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3387new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3388to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3389process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3390already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3391HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3392evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3393one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3394
3395There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3396performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3397tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3398preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3399analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3400HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3401header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3402mitigate this drawback.
3403
3404It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3405method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3406set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3407in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3408is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3409to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3410above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3411to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3412"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3413frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3414frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3415as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3416upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3417on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3418the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3419upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3420frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3421remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034234.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3424--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003426The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3427limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3428they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3429limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003430marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003431option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003432and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3433with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3434specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003436
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003437 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3438------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3439acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003440backlog X X X -
3441balance X - X X
3442bind - X X -
3443bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444capture cookie - X X -
3445capture request header - X X -
3446capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003447clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3448clitcpka-idle X X X -
3449clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003450compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003451cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003452declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003453default-server X - X X
3454default_backend X X X -
3455description - X X X
3456disabled X X X X
3457dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003458email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003459email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003460email-alert mailers X X X X
3461email-alert myhostname X X X X
3462email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003463enabled X X X X
3464errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003465errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003466errorloc X X X X
3467errorloc302 X X X X
3468-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3469errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003470force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003471filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003472fullconn X - X X
3473grace X X X X
3474hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003475http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003476http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003477http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003478http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003479http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003480http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003481http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003482http-check set-var X - X X
3483http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003484http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003486http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003487http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003488http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003489id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003490ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003491load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003492log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003493log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003494log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003495log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003496max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003497maxconn X X X -
3498mode X X X X
3499monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003500monitor-uri X X X -
3501option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3502option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3503option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3504option allbackups (*) X - X X
3505option checkcache (*) X - X X
3506option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3507option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003508option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003509option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3510option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003511-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3512option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003513option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3514option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003515option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003516option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003517option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003518option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003519option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003520option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3521option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3522option httpchk X - X X
3523option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003524option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003525option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003526option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003527option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003528option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3530option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3531option logasap (*) X X X -
3532option mysql-check X - X X
3533option nolinger (*) X X X X
3534option originalto X X X X
3535option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003536option pgsql-check X - X X
3537option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003539option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540option smtpchk X - X X
3541option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3542option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3543option splice-request (*) X X X X
3544option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003545option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003546option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3547option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3548-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003549option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3551option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3552option tcpka X X X X
3553option tcplog X X X X
3554option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003555external-check command X - X X
3556external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3558rate-limit sessions X X X -
3559redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003561retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003562retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003564server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003565server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003566source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003567srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3568srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3569srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003570stats admin - X X X
3571stats auth X X X X
3572stats enable X X X X
3573stats hide-version X X X X
3574stats http-request - X X X
3575stats realm X X X X
3576stats refresh X X X X
3577stats scope X X X X
3578stats show-desc X X X X
3579stats show-legends X X X X
3580stats show-node X X X X
3581stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3583stick match - - X X
3584stick on - - X X
3585stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003586stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003587stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003588tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003589tcp-check connect X - X X
3590tcp-check expect X - X X
3591tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003592tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003593tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003594tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003595tcp-check set-var X - X X
3596tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003597tcp-request connection - X X -
3598tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003599tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003600tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003601tcp-response content - - X X
3602tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003603timeout check X - X X
3604timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003605timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003607timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3608timeout http-request X X X X
3609timeout queue X - X X
3610timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003611timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003612timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003613timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003615unique-id-format X X X -
3616unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003618use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003619use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3621 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036244.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3625---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626
3627This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3628
3629
3630acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3631 Declare or complete an access list.
3632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 no | yes | yes | yes
3634 Example:
3635 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3636 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3637 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003639 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
3641
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003642backlog <conns>
3643 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments :
3647 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3648 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003649 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003650
3651 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3652 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3653 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3654 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3655 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3656 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3657 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3658 backlog parameter.
3659
3660 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3661 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3662 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3663
3664 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3665
3666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003668balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | no | yes | yes
3672 Arguments :
3673 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3674 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3675 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3676 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3677
3678 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3679 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3680 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3681 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003682 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003683 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003684 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3685 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3686 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3687 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3688 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3689 it, so that you don't worry.
3690
3691 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3692 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3693 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3694 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3695 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3696 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3697 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3698 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003700 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3701 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3702 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3703 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3704 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3705 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3706 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003707 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3708 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3709 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003710
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003711 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003712 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003713 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3714 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003715 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003716 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3717 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3718 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3719 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3720 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003721 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3722 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3723 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3724 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3725 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3726 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3729 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3730 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3731 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3732 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3733 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3734 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3735 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003736 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003738 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3739 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3740 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003741
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003742 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3743 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3744 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3745 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3746 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3747 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3748 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3749 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3750 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3751 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3752 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3753 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003755 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003756 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3757 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3758 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3759 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3760 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3761 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3762 URIs start with a leading "/".
3763
3764 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3765 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3766 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3767 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3768
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003769 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3770 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3771 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3772 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003774 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003775 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3776
3777 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003778 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3779 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003780 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3781 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3782 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3783 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003784 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003785 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3786 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003787
3788 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3789 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3790 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3791 server will receive the request.
3792
3793 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3794 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3795 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3796 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3797 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003798 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3799 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3800 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003801
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003802 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3803 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3804 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3805 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3806 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003808 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003809 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3810 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3811 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3812
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003813 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3814 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3815 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3816
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003817 random
3818 random(<draws>)
3819 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003820 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3821 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3822 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3823 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003824 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3825 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3826 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3827 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3828 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3829 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3830 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3831 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3832 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3833 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3834 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3835 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3836 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3837 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3838 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3839 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3840 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3841 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3842 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3843 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003844
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003845 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003846 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003847 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3848 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3849 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3850 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3851 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3852 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003853 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003854 used instead.
3855
3856 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3857 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3858 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3859 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3860
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003861 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3862 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3863 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3864
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003865 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003868 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3869 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003870
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003871 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3872 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3873 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003875 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003876 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003877 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3878 NTLM relies on.
3879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003880 Examples :
3881 balance roundrobin
3882 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003883 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003884 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3885 balance hdr(host)
3886 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003887
3888 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3889 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003891 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003892 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3893 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3894 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003895 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003896
3897 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3898 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3899 defaults to 16 kB.
3900
3901 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3902 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3903
3904 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3905 Round Robin.
3906
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003907 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003908 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3909 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3910 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3911
3912 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3913
3914 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003915 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003916 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3917 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3918 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003920 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003921
3922
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003923bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3924bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003925 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3927 no | yes | yes | no
3928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003929 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3930 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3931 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3932 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003933 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003934 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3935 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3936 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3937 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3938 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3939 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003940 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003941 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3942 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003943 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003944 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3945 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003946 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003947 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3948 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003949 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003950 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3951 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3952 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3953 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3954 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3955 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3956 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003957 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3958 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3959 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003960 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3961 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3962 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3963 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003964 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3965 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3966 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003967
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003968 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3969 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003970 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3971 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3972 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003973 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3974 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3975 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3976 the range.
3977
3978 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3979 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3980 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3981 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3982 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3983 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3984 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003985 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003986 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003988 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003989 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003990 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3991 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3992 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3993 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3994 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3995 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003997 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3998 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3999 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4000 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4003 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4004 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4005 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4006 in a frontend.
4007
4008 Example :
4009 listen http_proxy
4010 bind :80,:443
4011 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004012 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004014 listen http_https_proxy
4015 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004016 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004017
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004018 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4019 bind ipv6@:80
4020 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4021 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4022
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004023 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004024 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004025
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004026 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4027 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4028 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4029 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4030 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4031
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004032 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004033 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034
4035
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004036bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004037 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | yes | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4042 may be used to override a default value.
4043
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004044 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004045 option may be combined with other numbers.
4046
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004047 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004048 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4049 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4050 missing from all processes.
4051
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004052 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004053 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004054 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4055 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4056 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4057 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4058 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004059 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004060
4061 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4062 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4063 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4064 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4065 and 'even' instances.
4066
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004067 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4068 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4069 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4070 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004071
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004072 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4073 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4074
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004075 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4076 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4077 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4078
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004079 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4080 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4081
4082 Example :
4083 listen app_ip1
4084 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004085 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004086
4087 listen app_ip2
4088 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004089 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004090
4091 listen management
4092 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004093 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004094
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004095 listen management
4096 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4097 bind-process 1-4
4098
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004099 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004100
4101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004102capture cookie <name> len <length>
4103 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 no | yes | yes | no
4106 Arguments :
4107 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4108 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4109 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4110 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004111 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112
4113 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4114 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4115 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4116 right if it exceeds <length>.
4117
4118 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4119 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4120 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4121 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4122
4123 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4124 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4125 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4126
4127 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4128 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4129 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004130 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4131 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4132 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
4134 Example:
4135 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4136
4137 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004138 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004139
4140
4141capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004142 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4144 no | yes | yes | no
4145 Arguments :
4146 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004147 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4149 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4150 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4151
4152 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4153 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4154 it exceeds <length>.
4155
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004156 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4158 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004159 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4160 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4161 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4162 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004163 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004164 environments to find where the request came from.
4165
4166 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4167 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4168 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4169 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004170
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004171 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4172 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4173 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4174 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4175 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004176
4177 Example:
4178 capture request header Host len 15
4179 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004180 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004182 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004183 about logging.
4184
4185
4186capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004187 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4189 no | yes | yes | no
4190 Arguments :
4191 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004192 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4194 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4195 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4196
4197 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4198 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4199 it exceeds <length>.
4200
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004201 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004202 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4203 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4204 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004205 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4206 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4207 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4208 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004210 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4211 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4212 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4213 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4214 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
4216 Example:
4217 capture response header Content-length len 9
4218 capture response header Location len 15
4219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004220 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221 about logging.
4222
4223
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004224clitcpka-cnt <count>
4225 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4226 the connection on the client side.
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 yes | yes | yes | no
4229 Arguments :
4230 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4231
4232 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4233 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004234 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4235 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004236
4237 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4238
4239
4240clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4241 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4242 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4243 client side.
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4245 yes | yes | yes | no
4246 Arguments :
4247 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4248 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4249 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4250 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4251
4252 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4253 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004254 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4255 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004256
4257 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4258
4259
4260clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4261 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4263 yes | yes | yes | no
4264 Arguments :
4265 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4266 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4267 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4268 document.
4269
4270 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4271 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004272 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4273 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004274
4275 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4276
4277
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004278compression algo <algorithm> ...
4279compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004280compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004281 Enable HTTP compression.
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 yes | yes | yes | yes
4284 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004285 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4286 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4287 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4288
4289 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004290 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4291 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4292 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004293
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004294 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004295 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004296
4297 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4298 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4299 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4300 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4301 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004302 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004303
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004304 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4305 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4306 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4307 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4308 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4309 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4310 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004311 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004312
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004313 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004314 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004315 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4316 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4317 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4318 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4319 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004320
4321 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4322 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4323 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4324 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4325 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004326 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4327 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4328 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4329 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4330 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004331 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4332 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004333
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004334 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004335 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4336 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004337 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004338 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004339 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4340 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4341 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4342 "multipart"
4343 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4344 header
4345 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4346 and later
4347 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4348 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004349 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004350
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004351 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004352
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004353 Examples :
4354 compression algo gzip
4355 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004356
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004357
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004358cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004359 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4360 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004361 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004362 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | no | yes | yes
4365 Arguments :
4366 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4367 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4368 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4369 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4370 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4371 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004372 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004373 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4374 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4375
4376 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4377 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4378 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4379 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4380 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4381 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004382 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4383 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004384 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004385 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4386 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387
4388 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004389 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004390
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004391 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004392 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004393 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004394 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004395 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4396 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4397 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4398 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4399 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4400 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4401 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004402
4403 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4404 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4405 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4406 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4407 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4408 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4409 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4410 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4411 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004412 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004413 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4414 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4415 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004416
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004417 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4418 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4419 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004420 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4421 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4422 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4423 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004424 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4425 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4426 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004427
4428 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4429 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4430 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4431 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4432 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4433 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4434 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4435 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4436 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4437
4438 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4439 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4440 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4441 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4442 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4443 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4444 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4445 persistence cookie in the cache.
4446 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4447
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004448 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4449 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4450 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4451 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4452 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004453 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004454 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4455 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4456 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4457 they logout.
4458
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004459 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4460 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4461 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4462 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4463
4464 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4465 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4466 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4467 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4468 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4469 this attribute.
4470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004471 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004472 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004473 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4474 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4475 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4476 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4477 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4478 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004479
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004480 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4481 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4482 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4483 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4484 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4485 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4486 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4487 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004488 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004489 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4490 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4491 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4492 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4493 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4494 the site.
4495
4496 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4497 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4498 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4499 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4500 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4501 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4502 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4503 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4504 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4505 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4506 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4507 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4508 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004509 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004510 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4511 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4512
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004513 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4514 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4515 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4516 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4517 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4518 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4519
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004520 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4521 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4522 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4523 repeated.
4524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004525 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4526 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4527 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4528 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004530 Examples :
4531 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4532 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4533 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004534 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004535
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004536 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004537
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004538
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004539declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4540 Declares a capture slot.
4541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 no | yes | yes | no
4543 Arguments:
4544 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4545
4546 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4547 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4548 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4549 for use in the response.
4550
4551 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004552 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004553 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4554
4555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004556default-server [param*]
4557 Change default options for a server in a backend
4558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4559 yes | no | yes | yes
4560 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004561 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4562 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4563 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4564 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004565
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004566 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004567 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4568
4569 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004572default_backend <backend>
4573 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 yes | yes | yes | no
4576 Arguments :
4577 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4578
4579 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4580 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4581 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4582 will catch all undetermined requests.
4583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004584 Example :
4585
4586 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4587 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4588 default_backend dynamic
4589
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004590 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004592
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004593description <string>
4594 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 no | yes | yes | yes
4597 Arguments : string
4598
4599 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4600 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4601 it describes.
4602 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4603
4604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605disabled
4606 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments : none
4610
4611 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4612 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4613 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4614 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4615 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4616 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4617 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4618
4619 See also : "enabled"
4620
4621
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004622dispatch <address>:<port>
4623 Set a default server address
4624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4625 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004626 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004627
4628 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4629 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4630 during start-up.
4631
4632 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4633 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4634 possible with normal servers.
4635
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004636 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004637 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4638 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4639 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4640 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4641
4642 See also : "server"
4643
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004644
4645dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4646 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 yes | no | yes | yes
4649 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4650
4651 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004652 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004653 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4654 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004655 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004656 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004658enabled
4659 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | yes | yes | yes
4662 Arguments : none
4663
4664 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4665 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4666
4667 See also : "disabled"
4668
4669
4670errorfile <code> <file>
4671 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004676 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004677 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004678
4679 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004680 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004681 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004682 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4683 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004684
4685 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4686 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4687 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4688
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004689 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4690
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004691 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4692 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4693 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4694 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4695 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4696 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4697 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4698 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4699 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4702 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4703 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004704 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4706
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004707 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004709 Example :
4710 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004711 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004712 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4713 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004715
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004716errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4717 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4718 section.
4719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 yes | yes | yes | yes
4721 Arguments :
4722 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4723
4724 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004725 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004726 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4727 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004728
4729 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4730 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4731 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4732 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4733 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004734 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004735 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4736
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004737 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4738 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004739
4740 Example :
4741 errorfiles generic
4742 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4743
4744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004745errorloc <code> <url>
4746errorloc302 <code> <url>
4747 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | yes | yes | yes
4750 Arguments :
4751 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004752 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004753 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754
4755 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4756 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4757 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4758 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004759 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760
4761 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4762 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4763 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4764
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004765 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004767 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4768 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4769 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4770 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004771 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4773 request.
4774
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004775 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004776
4777
4778errorloc303 <code> <url>
4779 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | yes | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004784 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004785 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004786
4787 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4788 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4789 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4790 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004792
4793 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4794 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4795 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4796
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004797 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4798
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004799 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4800 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4801 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4802 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004803 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004804
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004805 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004806
4807
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004808email-alert from <emailaddr>
4809 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004810 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | yes | yes | yes
4813
4814 Arguments :
4815
4816 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4817
4818 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4819 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4820
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004821 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004822 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4823 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004824
4825
4826email-alert level <level>
4827 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4828 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4830 yes | yes | yes | yes
4831
4832 Arguments :
4833
4834 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4835 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4836 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4837
4838 By default level is alert
4839
4840 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4841 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4842 for the proxy.
4843
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004844 Alerts are sent when :
4845
4846 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4847 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4848 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4849 is notice or lower
4850 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4851 and a health check status update occurs
4852
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004853 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4854 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004855 section 3.6 about mailers.
4856
4857
4858email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4859 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4861 yes | yes | yes | yes
4862
4863 Arguments :
4864
4865 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4866
4867 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4868 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4869
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004870 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4871 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004872
4873
4874email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4875 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4876 mailers.
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | yes | yes | yes
4879
4880 Arguments :
4881
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004882 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004883
4884 By default the systems hostname is used.
4885
4886 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4887 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4888 for the proxy.
4889
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004890 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4891 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004892
4893
4894email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004895 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004896 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4897 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | yes
4899
4900 Arguments :
4901
4902 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4903
4904 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4905 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4906
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004907 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004908 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4909
4910
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004911force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4912 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004914 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004915
4916 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4917 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4918 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4919 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4920 marked down for maintenance operations.
4921
4922 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4923 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4924 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4925 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4926 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4927 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4928 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4929 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4930 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4931
4932 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4933 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4934 is used.
4935
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004936 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004937 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004938
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004939
4940filter <name> [param*]
4941 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4943 no | yes | yes | yes
4944 Arguments :
4945 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4946 referenced in section 9.
4947
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004948 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004949 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004950 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4951 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004952
4953 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4954 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4955
4956 Example:
4957 listen
4958 bind *:80
4959
4960 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4961 filter compression
4962 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4963
4964 compression algo gzip
4965 compression offload
4966
4967 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4968
4969 See also : section 9.
4970
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004971
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004972fullconn <conns>
4973 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4975 yes | no | yes | yes
4976 Arguments :
4977 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4978 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4979
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004980 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004981 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004982 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004983 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4984 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4985 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4986 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4987 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004988 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004989
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004990 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4991 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004992 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4993 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4994 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004996 Example :
4997 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4998 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4999 # connections.
5000 backend dynamic
5001 fullconn 10000
5002 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5003 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5004
5005 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5006
5007
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005008grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005009 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005011 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005012 Arguments :
5013 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5014 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5015 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5016
5017 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5018 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005019 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005020 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5021
5022 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5023 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5024 simplify it.
5025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005026
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005027hash-balance-factor <factor>
5028 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | no | no | yes
5031 Arguments :
5032 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5033 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005034 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005035
5036 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5037 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5038 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5039 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5040 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5041 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5042 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5043
5044 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5045 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5046 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5047 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5048 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5049
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005050 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5051 consistent hashing mechanism.
5052
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005053 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5054
5055
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005056hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005057 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | no | yes | yes
5060 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005061 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5062 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005063
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005064 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5065 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5066 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5067 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5068 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5069 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5070 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5071 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5072 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5073 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005074
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005075 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5076 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5077 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5078 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5079 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5080 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5081 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5082 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5083 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5084 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5085 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5086 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5087 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005088 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5089 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005090
5091 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5092
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005093 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005094 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5095 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5096 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005097 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5098 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5099 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005100
5101 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5102 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005103 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5104 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5105 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5106 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5107
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005108 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5109 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5110 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5111 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5112 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5113 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5114 parameter.
5115
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005116 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5117 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5118 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5119 used on strings.
5120
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005121 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5122
5123 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5124 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5125 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5126 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5127 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5128 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5129 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5130 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5131 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5132 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5133 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5134 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005135
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005136 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5137 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5138 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005139
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005140 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005141
5142
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005143http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5144 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5145 ones).
5146
5147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 no | yes | yes | yes
5149
5150 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5151 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5152 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5153 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5154 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5155 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5156
5157 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5158 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5159 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5160
5161 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5162 below.
5163
5164 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5165 instance.
5166
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005167 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5168 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5169 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5170
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005171 Example:
5172 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5173 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5174 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5175
5176http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177
5178 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5179 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5180 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5181 example, or to pass some internal information.
5182 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5183 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5184 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5185
5186http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187
5188 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5189 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5190
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005191http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005192
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005193 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5194 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5195 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5196 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5197 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005198
5199http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5200 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5201
5202 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5203
5204 Example:
5205 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5206
5207 # applied to:
5208 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5209
5210 # outputs:
5211 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5212
5213 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5214
5215http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5216 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5217
5218 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5219
5220 Example:
5221 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5222
5223 # applied to:
5224 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5225
5226 # outputs:
5227 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5228
5229http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5230
5231 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5232 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5233 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5234
5235http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5237
5238 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5239 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5240 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5241 fallback.
5242
5243 Example:
5244 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5245 http-response set-status 431
5246 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5247 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5248
5249http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5250
5251 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5252 inline.
5253
5254 Arguments:
5255 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5256 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5257 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5258 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5259 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5260 (request and response)
5261 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5262 processing
5263 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5264 processing
5265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5266 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5267 and '_'.
5268
5269 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5270 followed by some converters.
5271
5272 Example:
5273 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5274
5275http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5276
5277 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5278 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5279 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5280 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5281 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005282 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005283 processing.
5284
5285 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5286 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005287 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005288 rules evaluation.
5289
5290http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5291
5292 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5293 details about <var-name>.
5294
5295 Example:
5296 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5297
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005298
5299http-check comment <string>
5300 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5301 it fails.
5302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | no | yes | yes
5304
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005305 Arguments :
5306 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5307 rule fails.
5308
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005309 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5310 user-friendly error reporting.
5311
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005312 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005313 "http-check expect".
5314
5315
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005316http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5317 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005318 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005319 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | no | yes | yes
5322
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005323 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005324 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5325
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005326 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005327 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005328
5329 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5330 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5331 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5332 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5333
5334 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5335
5336 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5337
5338 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5339
5340 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5341
5342 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5343
5344 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5345 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5346 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5347 is used.
5348
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005349 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5350 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5351 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5352 haproxy -vv.
5353
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005354 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5355
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005356 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5357 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5358 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5359 different ports or with different servers.
5360
5361 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5362 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5363 the port with a "http-check connect".
5364
5365 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5366 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5367 do.
5368
5369 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5370 unset-var or comment rules.
5371
5372 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005373 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5374 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5375 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5376 option httpchk
5377
5378 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005379 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005380 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005381 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005382 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005383 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005384
5385 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5386
5387 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005388
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005390http-check disable-on-404
5391 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005394 Arguments : none
5395
5396 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5397 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5398 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5399 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5400 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5401 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5402 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5403 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005404 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5405 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005406 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5407 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5408 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005409
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005410 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005411
5412
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005413http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005414 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5415 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5416 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005417 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005419 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005420
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005421 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005422 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5423
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005424 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5425 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5426 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5427 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5428 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5429 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5430 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5431 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5432 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5433 result is always conclusive.
5434
5435 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5436 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5437 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005438 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5439 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005440 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5441 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005442 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5443 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5444 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005445
5446 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5447 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005448 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5449 supported :
5450 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5451 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005452 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5453 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5454 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5455 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5456 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457
5458 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5459 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005460 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5461 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5462 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5463 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005464 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5465
5466 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5467 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5468 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5469 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5470
5471 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5472 informational message reported in logs if an error
5473 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5474 log-format string.
5475
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005476 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005477 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5478 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005479 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5480 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5481 details on the supported keywords.
5482
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005483 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5484 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5485 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5486 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005487
5488 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5489 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5490 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5491 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5492 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5493
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005494 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5495 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5496 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5497 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5498 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5499 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5500 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005501
5502 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005503 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005504 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5505 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5506 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5507 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5508
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005509 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5510 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005511 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5512 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5513 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5514 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5515 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5516 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5517 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5518 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005519 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5520 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5521 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5522 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5523 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5524 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5525 insensitive on the header names.
5526
5527 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5528 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5529 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5530 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5531 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5532 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005533
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005534 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005535 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005536 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5537 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5538 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5539 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5540 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005541 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005542 trace).
5543
5544 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005545 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005546 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5547 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5548 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5549 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5550 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005551 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005553 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5554 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5555 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5556 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5557 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5558 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005561 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005562 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5563 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5564 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5565 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5566 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5567 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5568
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005569 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5570 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5571 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5572 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5573 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005574
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005575 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5576 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5577
5578 Examples :
5579 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005580 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005582 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5583 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5584
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005585 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005586 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587
5588 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005589 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005590
5591 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005592 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005593
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005594 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005595 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005596
5597
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005598http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005599 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5600 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005601 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5602 health checks.
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | no | yes | yes
5605 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005606 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5607
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5609 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5610 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5611 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5612 to invent non-standard ones.
5613
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005614 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5615 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5616 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5617 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5618
5619 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5620 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5621 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5622 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005623
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005624 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005625 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005626 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005627 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5628 to add it.
5629
5630 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5631 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5632 to the log-format rules.
5633
5634 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5635 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5636 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005637
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005638 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5639 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5640 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5641 request.
5642
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005643 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5644 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5645 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005646 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5647 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5648 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5649 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005650 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005651
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005652 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005653 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5654 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005655
5656 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5657 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5658 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5659 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5660 configured request authority.
5661
5662 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5663 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005664
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005665 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005666
5667
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005668http-check send-state
5669 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 yes | no | yes | yes
5672 Arguments : none
5673
5674 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5675 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5676 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5677 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5678 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5679
5680 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5681 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5682 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5683 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5684 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005685 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5686 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5687 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5688
5689 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5690 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5691 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5692
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005693 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5694 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5695 checked in multiple backends.
5696
5697 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5698 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5699
5700 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5701 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5702 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5703 one fails.
5704
5705 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5706 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5707 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5708
5709 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5710 server's queue.
5711
5712 Example of a header received by the application server :
5713 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5714 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5715
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005716 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5717 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005718
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005719
5720http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005721 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | no | yes | yes
5724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005725 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005726 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5727 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5728 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5729 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5730 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5731 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5732 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5733 and '-'.
5734
5735 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005737 Examples :
5738 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005739
5740
5741http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005742 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | no | yes | yes
5745
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005746 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5748 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5749 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5750 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5751 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5752 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5753 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5754 and '-'.
5755
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005756 Examples :
5757 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005759
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005760http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5761 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5762 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5763 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5764 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5766 yes | yes | yes | yes
5767 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005768 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005769 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005770 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005771 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005772
5773 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5774 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5775 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5776 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5777
5778 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5779 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5780 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5781 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5782
5783 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5784 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5785 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5786 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5787 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5788 chroot is performed.
5789
5790 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5791 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5792 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5793 considered.
5794
5795 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5796 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5797 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5798 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5799 considered as a raw string.
5800
5801 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5802 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5803 "content-type".
5804
5805 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5806 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5807 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5808 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5809 evaluated as a log-format string.
5810
5811 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5812 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5813 argument to "content-type".
5814
5815 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5816 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5817 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5818 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5819
5820 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5821 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5822 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5823 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5824 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5825 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5826 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5827 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5828
5829 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5830 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5831 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5832
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005833 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5834 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5835 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5836 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5837 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5838
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005839 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5840 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5841
5842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005843http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005844 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5845
5846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 no | yes | yes | yes
5848
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005849 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5850 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5851 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5852 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5853 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5856 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005860 Example:
5861 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5862 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5863 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005864
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005865 http-request allow if nagios
5866 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5867 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5868 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 Example:
5871 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5872 acl add path /addacl
5873 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005875 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005877 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5878 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005879
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005880 Example:
5881 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5882 acl setmap path /setmap
5883 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005885 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5888 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005889
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005890 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5891 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5896 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5897 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5898 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5899 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5900 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5901 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5902 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005905
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005906 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5907 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5908 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5909 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5910 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5911 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5912 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5913 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005917 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5918 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005919
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005923 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5924 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5925 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5926 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5927 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005929 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5930 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5931 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5932 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5933 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5934 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5935 instead.
5936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005937 Example:
5938 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5939 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005940
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005941http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005942
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005943 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5949 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5950 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5951 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5952 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5953 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5954 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5955 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5956 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5959 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5960 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005961 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5962
5963 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5964 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5965 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5966 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005968http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5971 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5972 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5973 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5974 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5975 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005976
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005977http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005978
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005979 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5980 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5981 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5982 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5983 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005985http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005987 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5988 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5989 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5990 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005993
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005994http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5995http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5996 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5997 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5998 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006000
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006001 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6002 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6003 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006004 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006005 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6006 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6007 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006009 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006010
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006011http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6012 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6013 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6014 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6015
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006016http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6017
6018 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6019 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6020 pointed by <resolvers>.
6021 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6022 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6023 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6024 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6025 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6026 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6027 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6028 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6029 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6030 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6031 to 0.0.0.0.
6032
6033 Example:
6034 resolvers mydns
6035 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6036 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6037 timeout retry 1s
6038 hold valid 10s
6039 hold nx 3s
6040 hold other 3s
6041 hold obsolete 0s
6042 accepted_payload_size 8192
6043
6044 frontend fe
6045 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6046 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6047 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6048
6049 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6050 # which mean DNS resolution error
6051 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6052
6053 default_backend be
6054
6055 backend b_503
6056 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6057 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6058 # 503 error page to end users
6059
6060 backend be
6061 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6062 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6063 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6064 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6065 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6066
6067 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6068 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6069
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006070http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6071
6072 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6073 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6074 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6075 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006076 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6077 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006078
6079 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6080
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006081http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006082http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006083http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006084http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006085http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006086http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6087http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006088
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006089 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6090
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006091 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6092 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6093 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6094 processing in your infrastructure.
6095
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006096 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6097 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6098 the supported backend.
6099
6100 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6101 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6102 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6103 number of segments in the path.
6104
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006105 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6106 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6107 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6108 when improperly combined.
6109
6110 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6111 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6112 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6113 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6114 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6115
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006116 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006117
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006118 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6119 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006120
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006121 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6122 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6123
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006124 Example:
6125 - /. -> /
6126 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6127 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6128 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006129
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006130 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6131 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6132
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006133 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006134 their preceding segment.
6135
6136 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6137 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6138
6139 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6140 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006141
6142 Example:
6143 - /foo/../ -> /
6144 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6145 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6146 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006147 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006148 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006149 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006150
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006151 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6152 removed as well:
6153
6154 Example:
6155 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6156 - /bar/../../ -> /
6157
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006158 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6159 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006160
6161 Example:
6162 - // -> /
6163 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6164
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006165 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6166 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6167
6168 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6169 ".", "_", and "~".
6170
6171 Example:
6172 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6173 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6174 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6175 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6176
6177 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6178 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6179
6180 Example:
6181 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6182 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6183
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006184 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006185 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006186
6187 Example:
6188 - /%6f -> /%6F
6189 - /%zz -> /%zz
6190
6191 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6192 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6193
6194 Example:
6195 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6196
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006197 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006198 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6199 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6200
6201 Example:
6202 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6203 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6204 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006206http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006208 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6209 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6210 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6211 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6212 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006214http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006216 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6217 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6218 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6219 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006221http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6222 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006223
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006224 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006225 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6226 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6227 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6228 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6229 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006230
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006231 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6232 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6233 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6234 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6235 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006236
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006237 Example:
6238 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6239
6240 # applied to:
6241 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6242
6243 # outputs:
6244 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6245
6246 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006247
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006248 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6249
6250 # applied to:
6251 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006252
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006253 # outputs:
6254 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006255
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006256http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6258
6259 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6260 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006261 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6262 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6263 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006264
6265 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6266 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6267 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6268
6269 Example:
6270 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6271 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6272
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006273 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6274 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6275 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6276 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6277
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006278http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6280
6281 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6282 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6283 query-string are replaced.
6284
6285 Example:
6286 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6287 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6288
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006289http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6290 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6291
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006292 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6293 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6294 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6295 against.
6296
6297 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6298 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6299 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006300
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006301 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6302 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6303 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6304 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6305 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6306 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6307 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6308 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6309 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006310 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6311 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006312
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006313 Example:
6314 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6315 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006316
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006317 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6318 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006320http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006322
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006323 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6324 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6325 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6326 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006327
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006328 Example:
6329 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006330
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006331 # applied to:
6332 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006333
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006334 # outputs:
6335 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006336
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006337http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6338 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6339 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006340 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6342
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006344 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6345 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006346 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006347 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006348 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006349 are followed to create the response :
6350
6351 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6352 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6353 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6354 ignored.
6355
6356 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6357 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006358 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006359 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6360 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006361
6362 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6363 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6364 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006365 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6366 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006367
6368 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6369 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6370 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006371 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006372 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006373 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006374
6375 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6376 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6377 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6378 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6379 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6380 as a raw content.
6381
6382 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6383 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6384 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6385 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6386 considered as a raw string.
6387
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006388 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006389 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6390 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6391 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6392
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006393 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6394 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006395 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006396
6397 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6398
6399 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006400 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006401 if { path /ping }
6402
6403 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6404 if { path /favicon.ico }
6405
6406 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6407 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6408 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006410http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6411http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006413 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6414 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6415 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006416
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006417http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6418 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006419
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006420 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6421 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6422 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6423 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006425http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006427 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6428 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6429 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6430 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6431 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006433 Arguments:
6434 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6435 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006437 Example:
6438 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6439 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006441 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6442 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006444http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006446 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6447 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6448 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006450 Arguments:
6451 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6452 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006454 Example:
6455 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6456 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006458 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6459 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6460 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006464 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6465 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6466 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6467 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6468 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006470 Example:
6471 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6472 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6473 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6474 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6475 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6476 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6477 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6478 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6479 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006481http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006483 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6484 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6485 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6486 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6487 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006492 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6493 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6494 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6495 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6496 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6497 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6498 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6499 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6500 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006502http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006504 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6505 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6506 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6507 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6508 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6509 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6510 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006512http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006514 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6515 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6516 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006518http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006520 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6521 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6522 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6523 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6524 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6525 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6526 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6527 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006529http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006531 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6532 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6533 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6534 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6535 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6536 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 Example :
6539 # prepend the host name before the path
6540 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006541
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006542http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6543
6544 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6545 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6546 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6551 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6552 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6553 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6554 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006556http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006558 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6559 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6560 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6561 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6562 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6563 values have higher priority.
6564 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6565 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6566 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6567 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6568 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6573 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6574 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6575 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6576 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6577 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6578 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006581
6582 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6584 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006586http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6587 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6588 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6589 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006590 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6591 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592
6593 Arguments :
6594 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6595 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006596
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006597 See also "option forwardfor".
6598
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006599 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6601 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6602
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006603 # After the masking this will track connections
6604 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6605 http-request track-sc0 src
6606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6608 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6609
6610http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6611
6612 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6613 expression.
6614
6615 Arguments:
6616 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6617 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006618
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006619 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6621 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6622
6623 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6624 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6625 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6626
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006627http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006628 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6629
6630 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6631 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6632 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6633 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6634 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6635
6636 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6637 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6638 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6639 results.
6640
6641 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006642 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6643 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6646
6647 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6648 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6649 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6650 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6651 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6652 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6653 information from the request.
6654
6655 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6656
6657http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6658
6659 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6660 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6661 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6662 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6663 path and the query string.
6664 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6665
6666http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6667
6668 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6669 inline.
6670
6671 Arguments:
6672 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6673 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6674 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6675 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6676 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6677 (request and response)
6678 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6679 processing
6680 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6681 processing
6682 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6683 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6684 and '_'.
6685
6686 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6687 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006688
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006689 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6693 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6696 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6697 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6698 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6699 agent name must be used.
6700
6701 Arguments:
6702 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6703
6704 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6705 configuration.
6706
6707http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6708
6709 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6710 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6711 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6712 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6713 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6714 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6715 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6716 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6717 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6718 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6719 action.
6720 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6721 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6722 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6723 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6724 you fully understand how it works.
6725
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006726http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6727
6728 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6729 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6730 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6731 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6732 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006733 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006734 processing.
6735
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006736 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006737 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6738 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6739 rules evaluation.
6740
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006741http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6742http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6743 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6744 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6745 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6746 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747
6748 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6749 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6750 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006751 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6752 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6753 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6754 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6755 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6756 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6757 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6758 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6759 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6760 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006761 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006762 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6763 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6764 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6765 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6766 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006767
6768http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6769http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6770http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6771
6772 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6773 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6774 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6775 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006776 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6778 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6779 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6780 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6781 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6782 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6783 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6784
6785 Arguments :
6786 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6787 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6788 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6789 select which table entry to update the counters.
6790
6791 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6792 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6793 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6794 that table until the session ends.
6795
6796 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6797 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6798 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6799 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6800 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6801 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6802 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6803 useful information.
6804
6805 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6806 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6807 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6808 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6809 checks that make use of it.
6810
6811http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6812
6813 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006814
6815 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006816 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006817
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006818http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6819
6820 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6821 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6822 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6823 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6824 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6825 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6826
6827 Arguments :
6828 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6829
6830 Example:
6831 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6832
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006833http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835
6836 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6837 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6838 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6839 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6840 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6841 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6842 http-buffer-request".
6843
6844 Arguments :
6845
6846 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6847 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6848
6849 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006850 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006851 bytes.
6852
6853 Example:
6854 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6855
6856 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006858http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006860 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6861 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6862 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006863
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006865http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006866 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6867
6868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 no | yes | yes | yes
6870
6871 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6872 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6873 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6874 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6875 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6876 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006878 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6879 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006881 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006883 Example:
6884 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006886 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006888 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6889 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006891 Example:
6892 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006894 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006896 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6897 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006899 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6900 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006902http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006904 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6905 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6906 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6907 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6908 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6909 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6910 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6911 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006913http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006915 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6916 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6917 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6918 example, or to pass some internal information.
6919 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6920 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6921 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006923http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6926 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006927
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006928http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006929
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006930 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006932http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006934 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6935 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6936 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6937 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6938 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6939 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6940 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006942 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6943 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6944 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6945 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6946 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006947
6948 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6949 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6950 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6951 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006953http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006955 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6956 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6957 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6958 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6959 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6960 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006961
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006962http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006963
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006964 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6965 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6966 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6967 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6968 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006972 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6973 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6974 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6975 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6976 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6977 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006978
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006979http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6980http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6981 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6982 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6983 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006985
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6987 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6988 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006989 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006990 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6991 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6992 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006993 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006994 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006996http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6999 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7000 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7001 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7002 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7003 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007005http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7006 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007007
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007008 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7009 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 Example:
7012 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 # applied to:
7015 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007017 # outputs:
7018 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007020 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7023 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007024
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007025 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007026 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 Example:
7029 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031 # applied to:
7032 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034 # outputs:
7035 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007036
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007037http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7038 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7039 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007040 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007041 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7042
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007043 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007044 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7045 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007046 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007047 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007048 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007049 are followed to create the response :
7050
7051 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7052 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7053 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7054 ignored.
7055
7056 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7057 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007058 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007059 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7060 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007061
7062 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7063 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7064 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007065 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7066 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007067
7068 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7069 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7070 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007071 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007072 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007073 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007074
7075 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7076 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7077 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7078 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7079 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7080 as a raw content.
7081
7082 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7083 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7084 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7085 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7086 considered as a raw string.
7087
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007088 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7089 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7090 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7091 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7092
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007093 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7094 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007095 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007096
7097 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7098
7099 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007100 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007101 if { status eq 404 }
7102
7103 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7104 string "This is the end !" \
7105 if { status eq 500 }
7106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007107http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7108http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7111 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7112 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007113
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007114http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7115 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007116
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007117 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7118 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7119 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7120 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7125 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7126 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7127 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7128 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007130 Arguments:
7131 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007133 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7134 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007136http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007138 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7139 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7140 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007142http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7143
7144 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7145 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7146 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7147 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7148 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7149
7150http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7151
7152 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7153 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7154 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7155 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7156 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7157 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7158 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7159 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7160 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7161
7162http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7163
7164 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7165 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7166 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7167 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7168 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7169 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7170 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7171
7172http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7173
7174 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7175 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7176 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7177 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7178 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7179 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7180 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7181 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7182
7183http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7184 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7185
7186 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7187 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7188 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7189 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007190
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007191 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007192 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7193 http-response set-status 431
7194 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7195 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007197http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007199 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7200 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7201 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7202 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7203 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7204 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7205 based on some information from the request.
7206
7207 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7208
7209http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7210
7211 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7212 inline.
7213
7214 Arguments:
7215 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7216 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7217 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7218 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7219 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7220 (request and response)
7221 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7222 processing
7223 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7224 processing
7225 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7226 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7227 and '_'.
7228
7229 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7230 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007231
7232 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007233 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007234
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007235http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7238 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7239 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7240 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7241 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7242 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7243 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7244 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7245 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7246 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7247 action.
7248 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7249 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7250 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7251 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7252 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007253
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007254http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7255
7256 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7257 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7258 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7259 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7260 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007261 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007262 processing.
7263
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007264 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007265 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007266 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007267 rules evaluation.
7268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7271http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007273 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7274 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7275 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7276 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7277 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7278 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7279
7280http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7281
7282 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7283 about <var-name>.
7284
7285 Example:
7286 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7287
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007288http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7289 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7290
7291 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7292 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7293 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7294 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7295 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7296 buffer is full.
7297
7298 Arguments :
7299
7300 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7301 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7302
7303 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007304 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007305 bytes.
7306
7307 Example:
7308 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007309
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007310http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7311 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7312
7313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7314 yes | no | yes | yes
7315
7316 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007317 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7318 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7319 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007320
7321 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7322
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007323 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7324 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7325 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7326 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7327 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7328 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7329 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7330 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7331 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7332 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007333
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007334 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7335 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7336 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7337 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7338 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7339 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7340 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007341 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7342 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7343 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7344 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7345 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7346 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007347
7348 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7349 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7350 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7351 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7352 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7353 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7354 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7355 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007356 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007357 downsides of rare connection failures.
7358
7359 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7360 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7361 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7362 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7363 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7364 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007365 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007366 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7367 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7368 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7369 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7370 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7371
7372 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007373 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7374 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7375 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7376 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007377
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007378 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7379 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007380
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007381 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007382
7383 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7384 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7385 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7386
7387 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7388
7389
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007390http-send-name-header [<header>]
7391 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7393 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007394 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007395 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7396
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007397 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7398 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7399 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7400 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7401 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7402 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7403 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7404 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7405 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7406 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7407 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7408 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7409 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7410 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7411 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7412 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007413
7414 See also : "server"
7415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007416id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007417 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7419 no | yes | yes | yes
7420 Arguments : none
7421
7422 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7423 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7424 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007425
7426
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007427ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7428 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007430 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007431
7432 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7433 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7434 and running).
7435
7436 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7437 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7438 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007439 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007440 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7441
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007442 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7443 "unless" condition is met.
7444
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007445 Example:
7446 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7447 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7448 ignore-persist if url_static
7449
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007450 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7451
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007452load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7453 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 yes | no | yes | yes
7456
7457 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7458 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7459 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007460 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007461 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7462 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7463 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7464 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7465
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007466 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007467 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007468 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007469
7470 Arguments:
7471 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7472 named "server-state-file".
7473
7474 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7475 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7476 name is used as a file name.
7477
7478 none don't load any stat for this backend
7479
7480 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007481 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7482 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7483 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007484 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007485 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007486
7487 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7488 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007490 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007491
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007492 global
7493 stats socket /tmp/socket
7494 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007495
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007496 defaults
7497 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007498
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007499 backend bk
7500 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7501 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007502
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007503
7504 Then one can run :
7505
7506 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7507
7508 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7509
7510 1
7511 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7512 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7513 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007515 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007516
7517 global
7518 stats socket /tmp/socket
7519 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7520
7521 defaults
7522 load-server-state-from-file local
7523
7524 backend bk
7525 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7526 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7527
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007528
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007529 Then one can run :
7530
7531 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7532
7533 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7534
7535 1
7536 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7537 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7538 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7539
7540 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7541 "show servers state"
7542
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007544log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007545log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007546 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007547no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007548 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007551
7552 Prefix :
7553 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7554 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7555 prefix does not allow arguments.
7556
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007557 Arguments :
7558 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7559 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7560 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7561 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7562 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7563 parameter.
7564
7565 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7566 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7567
7568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7569 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7570 standard syslog port).
7571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7573 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7574 standard syslog port).
7575
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7578 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007579 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007580
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007581 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7582 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7583 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7584 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7585 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7586 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7587 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7588 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7589 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7590 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7591 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7592 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7593 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7594 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7595 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7596 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007597 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7598 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007599
7600 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7601 and "fd@2", see above.
7602
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007603 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7604 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7605 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7606 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7607 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7608 having the logs instantly available.
7609
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007610 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7611 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7612 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7613
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007614 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7615 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007616
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007617 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7618 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7619 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7620 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7621 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7622 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7623 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7624 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7625 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7626 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007627 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007628
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007629 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7630 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7631 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7632 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7633 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7634
7635 <sample_size>
7636 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7637 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7638 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7639 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7640 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7641
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007642 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7643 one of the following :
7644
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007645 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7646 field is stripped. This is the default.
7647 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7648 rfc3164.
7649
7650 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007651 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7652
7653 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7654 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7655
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007656 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7657 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7658 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7659 designed to be used with a local log server.
7660
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007661 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7662 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7663 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7664 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7665 systemd logger consumes.
7666
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007667 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7668 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7669 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7670 used with a local log server.
7671
7672 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7673 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7674 designed to be used with a local log server.
7675
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007676 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7677 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7678 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7679 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7680
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007681 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7682
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007683 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7684 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7685 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7686
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007687 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7688 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7689 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7690 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007691
7692 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7693 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7694 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007695 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7696 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7697 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7698 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7699 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007700
7701 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7702
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007703 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7704 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7705 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007706
7707 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7708 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7709 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7710 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7711
7712 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7713 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007714
7715 Example :
7716 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007717 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7718 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7719 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007720 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007721 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7722 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007723 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007724
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007726log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007727 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7729 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007730
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007731 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7732 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7733 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7734 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7735 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007736
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007737 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7738 "option httplog" directives.
7739
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007740log-format-sd <string>
7741 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | no
7744
7745 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7746 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7747 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7748 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7749 which covers the log format string in depth.
7750
7751 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7752 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7753
7754 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7755 log format to "rfc5424".
7756
7757 Example :
7758 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7759
7760
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007761log-tag <string>
7762 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7764 yes | yes | yes | yes
7765
7766 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7767 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7768 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7769 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7770 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7771 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7772 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7773 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7774 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007775
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007776max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7777 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7779 yes | no | yes | yes
7780
7781 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7782 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7783 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7784 servers.
7785
7786 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7787 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7788 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7789 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7790 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007791 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007792 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7793 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7794 picking a different server.
7795
7796 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7797 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7798 even if they have to be queued.
7799
7800 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7801 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7802
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007803max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7804 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7805 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7806 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007807
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007808maxconn <conns>
7809 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7811 yes | yes | yes | no
7812 Arguments :
7813 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7814 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7815 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7816 closes.
7817
7818 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7819 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7820 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7821 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007822 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7823 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7824 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7825 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007826
7827 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7828 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7829 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7830
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007831 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7832 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007834 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7835
7836
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007837mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007838 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7840 yes | yes | yes | yes
7841 Arguments :
7842 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7843 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7844 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7845 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7846
7847 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7848 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7849 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7850 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7851 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7852
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007853 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7854 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7855 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007856
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007857 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007858 defaults http_instances
7859 mode http
7860
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007861
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007862monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007863 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7865 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007866 Arguments :
7867 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7868 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007869 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007870 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7871 backend and its backup.
7872
7873 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7874 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7875 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7876 servers in a list of backends.
7877
7878 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7879 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7880 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7881 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7882 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7883 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7884 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007885 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7886 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007887
7888 Example:
7889 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007891 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7892 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7893 monitor-uri /site_alive
7894 monitor fail if site_dead
7895
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007896 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007897
7898
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007899monitor-uri <uri>
7900 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7902 yes | yes | yes | no
7903 Arguments :
7904 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7905 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7906
7907 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7908 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7909 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7910 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7911 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7912 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7913 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7914 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7915
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007916 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007917 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7918 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7919 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7920 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7921 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7922 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007923
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007924 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7925 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7926 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7927 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007929 Example :
7930 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7931 frontend www
7932 mode http
7933 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7934
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007935 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007937
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007938option abortonclose
7939no option abortonclose
7940 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 yes | no | yes | yes
7943 Arguments : none
7944
7945 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7946 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7947 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7948 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007949 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007950 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7951 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7952 encountered while delivering the response.
7953
7954 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7955 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7956 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7957 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7958 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7959 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007960 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007961 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007962 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007963 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7964 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7965 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7966
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007967 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7968 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007969 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7970 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7971 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7972 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7973 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7974 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007975 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007976
7977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7979
7980 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7981
7982
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007983option accept-invalid-http-request
7984no option accept-invalid-http-request
7985 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 yes | yes | yes | no
7988 Arguments : none
7989
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007990 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007991 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007992 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007993 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7994 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7995 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7996 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7997 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007998 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7999 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8000 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8001 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008003 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008004 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8005 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8006 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008007
8008 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8009 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8010 been confirmed.
8011
8012 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8013 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008014 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8015 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008016 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8017
8018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8020
8021 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8022 stats socket.
8023
8024
8025option accept-invalid-http-response
8026no option accept-invalid-http-response
8027 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | no | yes | yes
8030 Arguments : none
8031
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008032 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008033 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008034 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008035 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8036 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8037 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8038 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8039 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008040 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8041 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8042 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008043
8044 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8045 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8046 been confirmed.
8047
8048 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8049 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8050 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8051 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8052
8053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8055
8056 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8057 stats socket.
8058
8059
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008060option allbackups
8061no option allbackups
8062 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8064 yes | no | yes | yes
8065 Arguments : none
8066
8067 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8068 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8069 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8070 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8071 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8072 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8073 order between the backup servers anymore.
8074
8075 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8076 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8077
8078 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8079 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8080
8081
8082option checkcache
8083no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008084 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 yes | no | yes | yes
8087 Arguments : none
8088
8089 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8090 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008091 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008092 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8093 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008094 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008095
8096 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008097 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008098 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008099 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8100 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008101 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008102 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008103 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8104 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008105 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008106 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8107 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008108 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008109 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8110 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8111 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8112 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8113 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8114 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8115 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8116 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8117 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8118
8119 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008120 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8121 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8122 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8123 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008124
8125 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8126 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008127 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008128 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008129
8130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8132
8133
8134option clitcpka
8135no option clitcpka
8136 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | no
8139 Arguments : none
8140
8141 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8142 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008143 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008144 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8145
8146 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8147 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8148 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8149 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8150
8151 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8152 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8153 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8154 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8155 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8156
8157 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8158
8159 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8160 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8161 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8162
8163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8165
8166 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8167
8168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008169option contstats
8170 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 yes | yes | yes | no
8173 Arguments : none
8174
8175 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8176 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8177 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8178 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008179 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8180 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8181 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8182 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8183 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008184
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008185option disable-h2-upgrade
8186no option disable-h2-upgrade
8187 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8188 connection.
8189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8190 yes | yes | yes | no
8191 Arguments : none
8192
8193 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8194 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8195 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8196 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008197 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8198 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8199 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8200 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8201 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8202 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008203
8204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008206
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008207option dontlog-normal
8208no option dontlog-normal
8209 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 yes | yes | yes | no
8212 Arguments : none
8213
8214 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8215 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8216 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8217 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8218 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8219 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8220 logged.
8221
8222 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8223 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8224 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008226 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008227 logging.
8228
8229
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008230option dontlognull
8231no option dontlognull
8232 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | yes | yes | no
8235 Arguments : none
8236
8237 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8238 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8239 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8240 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8241 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8242 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008243 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8244 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8245 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008246
8247 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008248 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008249 would not be logged.
8250
8251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8253
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008254 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008255 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008256
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008257
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008258option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008259 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8261 yes | yes | yes | yes
8262 Arguments :
8263 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8264 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008265 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008266 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008267
8268 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8269 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8270 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8271 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8272 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8273 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8274 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008275 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8276 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8277 possible that the client has already brought one.
8278
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008279 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008280 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008281 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008282 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008283 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008284 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008285
8286 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8287 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8288 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8289 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8290 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8291 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008292 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008293
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008294 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8295 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8296 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8297 are under the control of the end-user.
8298
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008299 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008300 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8301 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008302 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8303 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8304 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008305
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008306 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008307 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8308 frontend www
8309 mode http
8310 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8311
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008312 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8313 backend www
8314 mode http
8315 option forwardfor header X-Client
8316
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008317 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008318 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008319
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008320
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008321option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8322no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8323 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 yes | yes | yes | no
8326 Arguments : none
8327
8328 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8329 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8330 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8331 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8332 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8333 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8334 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8335
8336 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8337 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8338 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8339 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8340 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8341 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8342 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8343 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8344 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8345 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8346
8347 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8348
8349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8351
8352 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8353 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8354
8355
8356option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8357no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8358 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8360 yes | no | yes | yes
8361 Arguments : none
8362
8363 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8364 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8365 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8366 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8367 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8368 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8369 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8370
8371 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8372 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8373 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8374 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8375 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8376 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8377 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8378 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8379 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8380 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8381
8382 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8383
8384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8386
8387 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8388 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8389
8390
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008391option http-buffer-request
8392no option http-buffer-request
8393 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | yes | yes | yes
8396 Arguments : none
8397
8398 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8399 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8400 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8401 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8402 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8403 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008404 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8405 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8406 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8407 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008408
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008409 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8410 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008411
8412
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008413option http-ignore-probes
8414no option http-ignore-probes
8415 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8417 yes | yes | yes | no
8418 Arguments : none
8419
8420 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8421 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8422 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8423 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8424 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8425 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8426 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8427 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8428 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008429 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8430 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008431 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8432
8433 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8434 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8435 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8436 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8437 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8438 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8439 are often the only way to detect them.
8440
8441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8443
8444 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8445
8446
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008447option http-keep-alive
8448no option http-keep-alive
8449 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | yes | yes | yes
8452 Arguments : none
8453
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008454 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8455 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008456 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8457 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008458 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8459 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8460 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008461
8462 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8463 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008464 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8465 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8466 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8467 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8468 situations where this option may be useful :
8469
8470 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008472
8473 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8474 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8475
8476 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8477 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8478 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8479 request.
8480
8481 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8482 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008483 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8484 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8485 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008486
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008487 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8488 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8489 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8490 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8491 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8492 not set.
8493
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008494 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8495 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8496 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008497
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008498 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008499 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008500 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008501
8502
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008503option http-no-delay
8504no option http-no-delay
8505 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | yes | yes | yes
8508 Arguments : none
8509
8510 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8511 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8512 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8513 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8514 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8515 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8516 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8517 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8518 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8519 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8520 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8521 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8522 affected.
8523
8524 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8525 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8526 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8527 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8528 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8529 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8530 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8531 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8532 latency environments.
8533
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008534 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8535
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008536
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008537option http-pretend-keepalive
8538no option http-pretend-keepalive
8539 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008541 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008542 Arguments : none
8543
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008544 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008545 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8546 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8547 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8548 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8549 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8550 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8551 consider the response complete.
8552
8553 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8554 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8555 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8556 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008557 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008558 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8559
8560 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8561 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8562 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8563 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8564 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8565 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8566 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8567
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008568 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8569 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8570 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8571 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8572 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8573 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008574
8575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008578 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008579 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008580
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008581
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008582option http-server-close
8583no option http-server-close
8584 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 yes | yes | yes | yes
8587 Arguments : none
8588
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008589 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8590 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8591 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8592 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008593 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8594 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8595 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8596 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8597 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8598 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8599 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8600 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8601 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8602 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8603 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008604
8605 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8606 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8607 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8608 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008609 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8610 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008611
8612 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8613 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008614 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8615 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8616 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008617
8618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8620
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008621 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8622 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008623
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008624option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008625no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008626 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8628 yes | yes | yes | no
8629 Arguments : none
8630
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008631 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008632 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8633 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8634 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8635 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8636 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8637 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8638
8639 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8640 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008641 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8642 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8643 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008644
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008645 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8646 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8647 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8648 front of an existing proxy.
8649
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008650 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8651
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008652 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008653
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008654option httpchk
8655option httpchk <uri>
8656option httpchk <method> <uri>
8657option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008658 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8660 yes | no | yes | yes
8661 Arguments :
8662 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8663 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8664 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8665 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8666 ones.
8667
8668 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8669 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8670 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8671
8672 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8673 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8674 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008675 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008676
8677 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8678 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8679 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8680 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8681 the lack of any response.
8682
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008683 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8684 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8685 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8686 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8687
8688 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8689 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8690 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008692 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8693 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008694 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008695 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008696 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008697
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008698 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8699 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8700 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8701 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8702
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008703 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008704 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8705 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8706 backend https_relay
8707 mode tcp
8708 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8709 http-check send hdr Host www
8710 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008711
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008712 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8713 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8714 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008715
8716
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008717option httpclose
8718no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008719 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8721 yes | yes | yes | yes
8722 Arguments : none
8723
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008724 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8725 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8726 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8727 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008728 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008729
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008730 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8731 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008732 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008733 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8734 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008735
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008736 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8737 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8738 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008739
8740 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8741 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008742 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8743 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8744 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008745
8746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8748
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008749 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008750
8751
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008752option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008753 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008755 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008756 Arguments :
8757 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8758 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8759 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008760 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008761 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008762
8763 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8764 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8765 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8766 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8767 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8768 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8769 ports.
8770
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008771 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8772 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008773
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008774 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008776 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008777
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008778
8779option http_proxy
8780no option http_proxy
8781 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8783 yes | yes | yes | yes
8784 Arguments : none
8785
8786 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8787 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8788 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8789 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8790 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8791
8792 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8793 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008794 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8795 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008796
8797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8799
8800 Example :
8801 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8802 backend direct_forward
8803 option httpclose
8804 option http_proxy
8805
8806 See also : "option httpclose"
8807
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008808
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008809option independent-streams
8810no option independent-streams
8811 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | yes | yes | yes
8814 Arguments : none
8815
8816 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8817 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8818 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8819 receive data or not.
8820
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008822 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8823 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8824 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8825 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8826 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8827 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8828 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8829 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8830 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8831 socket buffers.
8832
8833 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8834 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8835 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8836 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8837 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8838
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008839 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008840
8841
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008842option ldap-check
8843 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8845 yes | no | yes | yes
8846 Arguments : none
8847
8848 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8849 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8850 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8851 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8852
8853 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8854 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8855
8856 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8857 configure it.
8858
8859 Example :
8860 option ldap-check
8861
8862 See also : "option httpchk"
8863
8864
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008865option external-check
8866 Use external processes for server health checks
8867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 yes | no | yes | yes
8869
8870 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8871 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8872 command".
8873
8874 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8875
8876 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8877
8878
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008879option log-health-checks
8880no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008881 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8883 yes | no | yes | yes
8884 Arguments : none
8885
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008886 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8887 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8888 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008889
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008890 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8891 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8892 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8893 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8894 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008897 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008898
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008899 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8900 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8901 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008902
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008903
8904option log-separate-errors
8905no option log-separate-errors
8906 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8908 yes | yes | yes | no
8909 Arguments : none
8910
8911 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8912 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8913 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8914 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8915 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8916 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8917 provides very important information.
8918
8919 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8920 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8921 error logs.
8922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008923 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008924 logging.
8925
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008926
8927option logasap
8928no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008929 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8931 yes | yes | yes | no
8932 Arguments : none
8933
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008934 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8935 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8936 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8937 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8938
8939 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8940 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8941 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8942 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8943 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008944 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008945 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8946 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8947 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8948 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008949 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008951 Examples :
8952 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8953 mode http
8954 option httplog
8955 option logasap
8956 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8957
8958 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8959 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8960 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8961 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008963 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008964 logging.
8965
8966
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008967option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008968 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8970 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008971 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008972 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8973 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008974 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8975 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008976
8977 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8978 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008979 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008980 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8981 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8982 in the MySQL table, like this :
8983
8984 USE mysql;
8985 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8986 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8987
8988 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008990 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8991 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8992 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8993 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8994 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8995 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8996 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8997
8998 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8999 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009000
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009001 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009002
9003 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9004 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9005 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9006 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009007 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9008 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009009
9010 See also: "option httpchk"
9011
9012
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009013option nolinger
9014no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009015 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009018 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009020 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009021 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9022 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9023 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9024 connections.
9025
9026 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9027 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009028 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9029 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9030 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9031 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9032 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9033 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9034 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9035 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9036 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9037 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9038 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9039 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9040 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009041
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009042 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9043 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9044 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9045 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9046 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009047
9048 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9049 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009050 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009051 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009052 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009053
9054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9056
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009057 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9058 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009059
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009060option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9061 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | yes | yes | yes
9064 Arguments :
9065 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9066 matching <network>
9067 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9068 header name.
9069
9070 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9071 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9072 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9073 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9074 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9075 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9076 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9077 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9078 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9079 possible that the client has already brought one.
9080
9081 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9082 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9083 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9084 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9085 header and requires different one.
9086
9087 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9088 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9089 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009090 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9091 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9092 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9093 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9094 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009095
9096 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9097 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9098 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9099 both are defined.
9100
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009101 Examples :
9102 # Original Destination address
9103 frontend www
9104 mode http
9105 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9106
9107 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9108 backend www
9109 mode http
9110 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9111
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009112 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009113
9114
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009115option persist
9116no option persist
9117 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009120 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009121
9122 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9123 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9124 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9125 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9126 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9127 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9128 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9129 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9130 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9131 redirected to another valid server.
9132
9133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9135
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009136 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009137
9138
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009139option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9140 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9142 yes | no | yes | yes
9143 Arguments :
9144 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9145 PostgreSQL server.
9146
9147 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9148 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9149 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9150 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9151
9152 See also: "option httpchk"
9153
9154
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009155option prefer-last-server
9156no option prefer-last-server
9157 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9158 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9159 yes | no | yes | yes
9160 Arguments : none
9161
9162 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9163 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9164 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9165 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9166 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9167 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9168 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9169 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9170 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009171 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9172 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009173 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9174 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9175 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009176 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9177 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9178 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009179
9180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9182
9183 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9184
9185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009186option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009187option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009188no option redispatch
9189 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009192 Arguments :
9193 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9194 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9195 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009196 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009197 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009198 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009199 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9200 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9201 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009203
9204 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9205 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9206 be able to access the service anymore.
9207
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009208 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9209 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009210
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009211 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9212 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9213 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9214 following order:
9215
9216 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9217
9218 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9219 list, or
9220
9221 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9222
9223 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9224 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9225
9226 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9227 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9228 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9229 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9230
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009231 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009232 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9233 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9237
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009238 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009239
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009240
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009241option redis-check
9242 Use redis health checks for server testing
9243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 yes | no | yes | yes
9245 Arguments : none
9246
9247 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9248 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9249 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9250 find the "+PONG" response message.
9251
9252 Example :
9253 option redis-check
9254
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009255 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009256
9257
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009258option smtpchk
9259option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9260 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9262 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009263 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009264 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009265 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009266 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9267
9268 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9269 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9270 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9271
9272 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9273 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9274 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9275 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9276 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9277 dead server.
9278
9279 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9280 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009281 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009282 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9283
9284 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9285 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9286 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9287 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009288 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009289
9290 Example :
9291 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9292
9293 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009296option socket-stats
9297no option socket-stats
9298
9299 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9301 yes | yes | yes | no
9302
9303 Arguments : none
9304
9305
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009306option splice-auto
9307no option splice-auto
9308 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 yes | yes | yes | yes
9311 Arguments : none
9312
9313 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9314 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009315 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009316 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009317 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009318 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9319 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9320 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9321 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9322
9323 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9324 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9325 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9326 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9327 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9328 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9329 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9330 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9331 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9332 keyword.
9333
9334 Example :
9335 option splice-auto
9336
9337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9339
9340 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9341 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9342
9343
9344option splice-request
9345no option splice-request
9346 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 yes | yes | yes | yes
9349 Arguments : none
9350
9351 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009352 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009353 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9354 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9355 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9356 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9357
9358 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9359
9360 Example :
9361 option splice-request
9362
9363 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9364 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9365
9366 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9367 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9368
9369
9370option splice-response
9371no option splice-response
9372 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9374 yes | yes | yes | yes
9375 Arguments : none
9376
9377 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009378 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009379 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9380 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9381 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9382 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9383
9384 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9385
9386 Example :
9387 option splice-response
9388
9389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9391
9392 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9393 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9394
9395
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009396option spop-check
9397 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9399 no | no | no | yes
9400 Arguments : none
9401
9402 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9403 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9404 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9405 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9406
9407 Example :
9408 option spop-check
9409
9410 See also : "option httpchk"
9411
9412
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009413option srvtcpka
9414no option srvtcpka
9415 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9417 yes | no | yes | yes
9418 Arguments : none
9419
9420 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9421 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009422 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009423 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9424
9425 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9426 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9427 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9428 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9429
9430 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9431 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9432 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9433 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9434 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9435
9436 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9437
9438 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9439 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9440 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9441
9442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9444
9445 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9446
9447
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009448option ssl-hello-chk
9449 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9451 yes | no | yes | yes
9452 Arguments : none
9453
9454 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9455 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9456 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9457 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9458 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9459 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9460 hello message.
9461
9462 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9463 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9464 messages, which is appreciable.
9465
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009466 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9467 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9468 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009469
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009470 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9471
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009472
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009473option tcp-check
9474 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | no | yes | yes
9477
9478 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9479 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9480
9481 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9482 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9483 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9484
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009485 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009486 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9487 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9488 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9489 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9490 only.
9491
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009492 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009493 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9494 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9495 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9496 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9497
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009498 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9500 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009501 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009502 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9503 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9504 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9505 the respective protocols.
9506 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009507 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009508
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009509 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009510
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009511 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9512 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9513 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9514 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009515
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009516 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9517 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9518 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009519
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009520
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009521 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009522 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009523 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009524 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009525
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009526 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009527 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009528 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009529
9530 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9531 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009532 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009533 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009534 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009535 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009536 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009537 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009538 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9539 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009540 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009541 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9542 tcp-check expect string +OK
9543
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009544 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009545 (send many headers before analyzing)
9546 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009547 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009548 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9549 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9550 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9551 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009552 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009553
9554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009555 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009556
9557
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009558option tcp-smart-accept
9559no option tcp-smart-accept
9560 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9562 yes | yes | yes | no
9563 Arguments : none
9564
9565 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9566 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9567 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9568 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9569 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9570 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9571
9572 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9573 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9574 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9575 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9576
9577 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9578 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9579 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009580 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009581
9582 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9583 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9584 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9585
9586 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9587 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9588 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9589
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009590 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9591
9592
9593option tcp-smart-connect
9594no option tcp-smart-connect
9595 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9597 yes | no | yes | yes
9598 Arguments : none
9599
9600 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9601 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9602 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9603 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9604 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9605
9606 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9607 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9608 complex.
9609
9610 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9611 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9612 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9613
9614 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9615 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9616
9617 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9618
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009619
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009620option tcpka
9621 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9623 yes | yes | yes | yes
9624 Arguments : none
9625
9626 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9627 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009628 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009629 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9630
9631 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9632 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9633 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9634 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9635
9636 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9637 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9638 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9639 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9640 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9641
9642 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9643
9644 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9645 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9646 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9647 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9648 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9649 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9650 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9651 backends.
9652
9653 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9654
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009655
9656option tcplog
9657 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009659 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009660 Arguments : none
9661
9662 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9663 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9664 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9665 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9666 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9667 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9668 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9669 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9670
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009671 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009673 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009674
9675
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009676option transparent
9677no option transparent
9678 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009681 Arguments : none
9682
9683 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9684 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9685 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9686 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9687 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9688 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9689 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9690 appropriate server.
9691
9692 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9693 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9694
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009695 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009696 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009697
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009699external-check command <command>
9700 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9702 yes | no | yes | yes
9703
9704 Arguments :
9705 <command> is the external command to run
9706
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009707 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9708
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009709 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009710
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009711 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9712 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9713 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9714 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9715 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9716 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009717
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009718 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9719
9720 Environment variables :
9721 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9722 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9723
9724 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9725
9726 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9727
9728 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9729 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9730 for a UNIX socket).
9731
9732 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9733
9734 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9735
9736 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9737
9738 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9739
9740 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9741
9742 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9743 socket).
9744
9745 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9746 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9747
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009748 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9749
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009750 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9751 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9752 failed.
9753
9754 Example :
9755 external-check command /bin/true
9756
9757 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9758
9759
9760external-check path <path>
9761 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9763 yes | no | yes | yes
9764
9765 Arguments :
9766 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9767
9768 The default path is "".
9769
9770 Example :
9771 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9772
9773 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9774 "external-check command"
9775
9776
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009777persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009778persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009779 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9781 yes | no | yes | yes
9782 Arguments :
9783 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009784 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9785 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009786
9787 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9788 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009790 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9791 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9792 forwarded to this server.
9793
9794 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9795 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9796 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009797 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009798 a single "listen" section.
9799
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009800 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9801 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9802 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9803
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009804 Example :
9805 listen tse-farm
9806 bind :3389
9807 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9808 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9809 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9810 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9811 persist rdp-cookie
9812 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009813 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009814 balance rdp-cookie
9815 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9816 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9817
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009818 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9819 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009820
9821
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009822rate-limit sessions <rate>
9823 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9825 yes | yes | yes | no
9826 Arguments :
9827 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9828 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9829
9830 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9831 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9832 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9833 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9834 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9835 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9836
9837 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9838 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9839 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9840 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9841
9842 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9843 listen smtp
9844 mode tcp
9845 bind :25
9846 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009847 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009848
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009849 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9850 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9851 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009852
9853 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9854
9855
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009856redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9857redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9858redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009859 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9861 no | yes | yes | yes
9862
9863 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009864 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009865
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009867 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009868 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9869 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9870 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009871
9872 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9873 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9874 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9875 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9876 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009877 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9878 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9879 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9880 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009881
9882 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9883 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9884 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9885 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9886 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9887 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009888 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009889 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009890 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9891 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9892 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009893
9894 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009895 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9896 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9897 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009898 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009899 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9900 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9901 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9902 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009903
9904 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009905 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009906
9907 - "drop-query"
9908 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9909 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9910 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9911 with a location-type redirect.
9912
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009913 - "append-slash"
9914 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9915 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9916 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9917 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9918
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009919 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9920 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9921 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9922 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9923 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9924 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9925 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9926
9927 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9928 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9929 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9930 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9931 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9932 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9933 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009934
9935 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9936 acl clear dst_port 80
9937 acl secure dst_port 8080
9938 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009939 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009940 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009941 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9942
9943 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009944 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9945 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9946 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009947 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009948
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009949 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9950 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9951 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9952
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009953 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009954 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009955
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009956 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009957 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9958 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9959 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009961 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009962
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009963
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009964retries <value>
9965 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9967 yes | no | yes | yes
9968 Arguments :
9969 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9970 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9971 default value is 3.
9972
9973 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9974 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9975 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9976
9977 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009978 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9979 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009980
9981 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9982 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9983
9984 See also : "option redispatch"
9985
9986
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009987retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009988 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9989 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9990 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9992 yes | no | yes | yes
9993 Arguments :
9994 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9995 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9996 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9997 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9998
9999 none never retry
10000
10001 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10002 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10003
10004 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10005 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10006 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10007 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10008 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10009 processing the request.
10010
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010011 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10012 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10013 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10014 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10015 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10016 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10017 overflow attack for example).
10018
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010019 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10020 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10021 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10022 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10023 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10024 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10025 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10026 amplify denial of service attacks.
10027
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010028 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10029 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10030 considered to be safe to retry.
10031
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010032 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10033 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10034 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10035 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10036 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010037
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010038 all-retryable-errors
10039 retry request for any error that are considered
10040 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10041 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10042 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10043
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010044 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10045 not cumulative.
10046
10047 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10048 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10049 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10050 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10051
10052 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10053 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10054 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10055 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10056 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10057 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10058 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10059 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10060 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10061 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10062 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10063 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10064
10065 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10066 should not use this directive.
10067
10068 The default is "conn-failure".
10069
10070 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10071
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010072server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010073 Declare a server in a backend
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10075 no | no | yes | yes
10076 Arguments :
10077 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010078 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010079 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010080
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010081 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10082 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10083 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10084 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010085 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10086 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10087 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10088 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10089 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010090 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10091 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10092 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10093 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10094 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10095 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10096 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010097 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010098 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10099 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10100 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10101 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10102 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10103 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010104 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10105 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010106 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10107 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010108
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010109 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010110 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10111 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10112 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10113 adding this value to the client's port.
10114
10115 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10116 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010117 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010118
10119 Examples :
10120 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10121 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010122 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010123 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10124 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10125 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010126
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010127 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10128 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10129 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10130 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10131 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10132
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010133 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10134 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010135
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010136server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010137 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010138 this backend.
10139 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10140 no | no | yes | yes
10141
10142 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10143 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10144 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10145 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10146 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010147
10148 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10149 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10150
10151 global
10152 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10153
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010154 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010155 load-server-state-from-file
10156
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010157 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010158 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010159
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010160server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10161 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10162 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10164 no | no | yes | yes
10165
10166 Arguments:
10167 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10168
10169 <num | range>
10170 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10171 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10172 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10173 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10174
10175 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10176
10177 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10178
10179 <params*>
10180 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10181 keyword.
10182
10183 Examples:
10184 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10185 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10186 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10187
10188 # or
10189 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10190
10191 # would be equivalent to:
10192 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10193 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10194 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10195
10196
10197
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010198source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010199source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010200source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010201 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10203 yes | no | yes | yes
10204 Arguments :
10205 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10206 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010207
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010208 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010209 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10210 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10211 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10212 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10213 supported prefixes are :
10214 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10215 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10216 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010217 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010218 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10219 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010220
10221 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10222 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010223 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10224 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10225 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010226
10227 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10228 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10229 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10230 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10231 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10232 <addr>.
10233
10234 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10235 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10236 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10237 port.
10238
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010239 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10240 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10241 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10242 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010243 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010244 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10245 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10246 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10247 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10248 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10249 HTTP header.
10250
10251 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10252 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010253 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010254 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10255 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10256 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10257 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10258 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10259 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10260 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10261
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010262 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10263 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10264 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10265 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10266 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10267 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10268
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010269 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10270 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10271 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10272 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10273
10274 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10275 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10276 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10277 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10278 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10279 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10280
10281 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10282 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10283 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10284 there are two methods :
10285
10286 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10287 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10288 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10289 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10290 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10291 of the client ranges may be used.
10292
10293 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10294 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10295 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10296 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10297 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10298 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10299 same session.
10300
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010301 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10302 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10303 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010304 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010305
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010306 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10307
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010308 Examples :
10309 backend private
10310 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10311 source 192.168.1.200
10312
10313 backend transparent_ssl1
10314 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10315 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10316
10317 backend transparent_ssl2
10318 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10319 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10320 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10321
10322 backend transparent_ssl3
10323 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10324 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10325 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10326
10327 backend transparent_smtp
10328 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10329 # with Tproxy version 4.
10330 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10331
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010332 backend transparent_http
10333 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10334 # proxy.
10335 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010337 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010338 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10339
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010340
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010341srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10342 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10343 the connection on the server side.
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10345 yes | no | yes | yes
10346 Arguments :
10347 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10348
10349 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10350 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010351 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10352 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010353
10354 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10355
10356
10357srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10358 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10359 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10360 server side.
10361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10362 yes | no | yes | yes
10363 Arguments :
10364 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10365 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10366 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10367 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10368
10369 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10370 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010371 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10372 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010373
10374 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10375
10376
10377srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10378 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10380 yes | no | yes | yes
10381 Arguments :
10382 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10383 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10384 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10385 document.
10386
10387 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10388 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010389 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10390 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010391
10392 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10393
10394
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010395stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10396 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010398 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010399
10400 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10401 matched.
10402
10403 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10404 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10405
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010406 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10407 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010409
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010410 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10411 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10412 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10413 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010414
10415 Example :
10416 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10417 backend stats_localhost
10418 stats enable
10419 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10420
10421 Example :
10422 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10423 backend stats_auth
10424 stats enable
10425 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10426 stats admin if TRUE
10427
10428 Example :
10429 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10430 userlist stats-auth
10431 group admin users admin
10432 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10433 group readonly users haproxy
10434 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10435
10436 backend stats_auth
10437 stats enable
10438 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10439 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10440 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10441 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10442
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010443 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10444 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10445 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010446
10447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010448stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10449 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010451 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010452 Arguments :
10453 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10454
10455 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10456
10457 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10458 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10459 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10460 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10461 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10462 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10463
10464 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10465 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10466 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010467 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010468
10469 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10470 report using "stats scope".
10471
10472 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10473 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10474 unobvious parameters.
10475
10476 Example :
10477 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10478 backend public_www
10479 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10480 stats enable
10481 stats hide-version
10482 stats scope .
10483 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010484 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010485 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10486 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10487
10488 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10489 backend private_monitoring
10490 stats enable
10491 stats uri /admin?stats
10492 stats refresh 5s
10493
10494 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10495
10496
10497stats enable
10498 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010500 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010501 Arguments : none
10502
10503 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10504 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10505 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10506 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10507 - stats auth : no authentication
10508 - stats scope : no restriction
10509
10510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10512 unobvious parameters.
10513
10514 Example :
10515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10516 backend public_www
10517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10518 stats enable
10519 stats hide-version
10520 stats scope .
10521 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010522 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10525
10526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10527 backend private_monitoring
10528 stats enable
10529 stats uri /admin?stats
10530 stats refresh 5s
10531
10532 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10533
10534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010535stats hide-version
10536 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010539 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010541 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10542 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10543 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10544 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10545 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10546 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010548 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10549 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10550 unobvious parameters.
10551
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010552 Example :
10553 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10554 backend public_www
10555 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010556 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010557 stats hide-version
10558 stats scope .
10559 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010560 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010561 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10562 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010563
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010564 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10565 backend private_monitoring
10566 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010567 stats uri /admin?stats
10568 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010569
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010570 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010571
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010572
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010573stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10574 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10575 Access control for statistics
10576
10577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10578 no | no | yes | yes
10579
10580 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10581 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10582 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10583 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10584 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10585 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10586
10587 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10588 instance.
10589
10590 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10591 about ACL usage.
10592
10593
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010594stats realm <realm>
10595 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010597 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010598 Arguments :
10599 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10600 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10601 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10602
10603 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10604 using a backslash ('\').
10605
10606 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10607 only related to authentication.
10608
10609 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10610 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10611 unobvious parameters.
10612
10613 Example :
10614 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10615 backend public_www
10616 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10617 stats enable
10618 stats hide-version
10619 stats scope .
10620 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010621 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010622 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10623 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10624
10625 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10626 backend private_monitoring
10627 stats enable
10628 stats uri /admin?stats
10629 stats refresh 5s
10630
10631 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10632
10633
10634stats refresh <delay>
10635 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010637 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010638 Arguments :
10639 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10640 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10641 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10642 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10643 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10644 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10645
10646 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10647 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10648 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010649 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010650
10651 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10652 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10653 unobvious parameters.
10654
10655 Example :
10656 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10657 backend public_www
10658 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10659 stats enable
10660 stats hide-version
10661 stats scope .
10662 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010663 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010664 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10665 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10666
10667 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10668 backend private_monitoring
10669 stats enable
10670 stats uri /admin?stats
10671 stats refresh 5s
10672
10673 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10674
10675
10676stats scope { <name> | "." }
10677 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010679 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010680 Arguments :
10681 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10682 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10683 section in which the statement appears.
10684
10685 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10686 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10687 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10688 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10689 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10690 exists.
10691
10692 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10693 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10694 unobvious parameters.
10695
10696 Example :
10697 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10698 backend public_www
10699 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10700 stats enable
10701 stats hide-version
10702 stats scope .
10703 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010705 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10706 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10707
10708 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10709 backend private_monitoring
10710 stats enable
10711 stats uri /admin?stats
10712 stats refresh 5s
10713
10714 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10715
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010716
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010717stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010718 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010721
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010722 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010723 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10724
10725 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10726 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10727
10728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010730 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010731
10732 Example :
10733 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10734 backend private_monitoring
10735 stats enable
10736 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10737 stats uri /admin?stats
10738 stats refresh 5s
10739
10740 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10741 global section.
10742
10743
10744stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010745 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10747 yes | yes | yes | yes
10748 Arguments : none
10749
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010750 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10752 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10753 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10754 - IP (socket, server)
10755 - cookie (backend, server)
10756
10757 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10758 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010759 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010760
10761 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10762
10763
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010764stats show-modules
10765 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10767 yes | yes | yes | yes
10768 Arguments : none
10769
10770 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10771 values as a tooltip.
10772
10773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10775 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10776
10777 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10778
10779
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010780stats show-node [ <name> ]
10781 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010783 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010784 Arguments:
10785 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10786 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10787
10788 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10789 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010790 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010791
10792 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10793 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10794 unobvious parameters.
10795
10796 Example:
10797 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10798 backend private_monitoring
10799 stats enable
10800 stats show-node Europe-1
10801 stats uri /admin?stats
10802 stats refresh 5s
10803
10804 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10805 section.
10806
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010807
10808stats uri <prefix>
10809 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010811 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010812 Arguments :
10813 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10814 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10815 query string.
10816
10817 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10818 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10819 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10820 possible to reach it in the application.
10821
10822 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010823 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010824 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10825 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10826 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10827 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10828
10829 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10830 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10831 an address or a port to statistics only.
10832
10833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10835 unobvious parameters.
10836
10837 Example :
10838 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10839 backend public_www
10840 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10841 stats enable
10842 stats hide-version
10843 stats scope .
10844 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010845 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010846 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10847 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10848
10849 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10850 backend private_monitoring
10851 stats enable
10852 stats uri /admin?stats
10853 stats refresh 5s
10854
10855 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10856
10857
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010858stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10859 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010861 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010862
10863 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010864 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010865 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010866 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010867 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10868
10869 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10870 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10871 the "stick-table" statement.
10872
10873 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10874 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10875 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10876 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10877 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10878
10879 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10880 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10881 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10882 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10883 transformation rules.
10884
10885 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10886 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10887 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10888 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10889 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10890 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10891 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10892
10893 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10894 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10895 ACL based conditions.
10896
10897 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10898 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10899 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10900 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10901
10902 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10903 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10904 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10905 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10906
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010907 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10908 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010909 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010910
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010911 Example :
10912 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10913 # last 30 minutes
10914 backend pop
10915 mode tcp
10916 balance roundrobin
10917 stick store-request src
10918 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10919 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10920 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10921
10922 backend smtp
10923 mode tcp
10924 balance roundrobin
10925 stick match src table pop
10926 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10927 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010929 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010930 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010931
10932
10933stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10934 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10936 no | no | yes | yes
10937
10938 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10939 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10940 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10941 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10942
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010943 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10944 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010945 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010946
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010947 Examples :
10948 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010949 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010950
10951 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10952 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10953 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10954
10955
10956 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10957 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10958 backend http
10959 mode http
10960 balance roundrobin
10961 stick on src table https
10962 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10963 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10964 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10965
10966 backend https
10967 mode tcp
10968 balance roundrobin
10969 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10970 stick on src
10971 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10972 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10973
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010974 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010975
10976
10977stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10978 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10980 no | no | yes | yes
10981
10982 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010983 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010984 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010986 server is selected.
10987
10988 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10989 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10990 the "stick-table" statement.
10991
10992 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10993 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10994 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10995 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10996 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10997 address.
10998
10999 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11000 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11001 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11002 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11003 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11004 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11005 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11006 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11007 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11008 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11009
11010 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11011 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11012 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11013 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11014 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11015 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11016 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11017
11018 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11019 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11020 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11021 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11022
11023 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11024 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11025 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11026 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11027 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11028 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011029 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11030 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11031 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11032 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11033 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11034 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011035
11036 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11037 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11038 the request.
11039
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011040 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11041 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011043
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011044 Example :
11045 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11046 # last 30 minutes
11047 backend pop
11048 mode tcp
11049 balance roundrobin
11050 stick store-request src
11051 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11052 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11053 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11054
11055 backend smtp
11056 mode tcp
11057 balance roundrobin
11058 stick match src table pop
11059 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11060 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11061
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011062 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011063 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011064
11065
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011066stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011067 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011068 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011069 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011071 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011072
11073 Arguments :
11074 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11075 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11076 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11077 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11078
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011079 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11080 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11081 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11082 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11083
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011084 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11085 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11086 instance.
11087
11088 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11089 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11090 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11091 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11092 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11093 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011094 to 32 characters.
11095
11096 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11097 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11098 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011099 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011100 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11101 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011102
11103 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011104 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11105 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011106 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11107 increase.
11108
11109 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011110 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11111 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11112 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011113
11114 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11115 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11116 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11117 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011118 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011119 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11120 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11121 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11122 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11123 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11124 parameter (see below).
11125
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011126 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11127 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11128 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11129 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11130 soft restart.
11131
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011132 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11133 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011134
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011135 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11136 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11137 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11138 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011139 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011140 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011141 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11142 if not expiration delay is specified.
11143
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011144 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11145 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11146 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11147 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11148 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11149 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11150 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11151 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11152 token.
11153
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011154 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11155 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11156 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11157 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011158 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11159 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11160 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11161 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11162 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11163 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11164 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11165 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11166 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11167 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11168 types and their arguments.
11169
11170 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11171 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11172 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11173 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11174
11175 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11176 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11177 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011178 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011179
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011180 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11181 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11182 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011183 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011184 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011185 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011186
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011187 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11188 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11189 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11190 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11191
11192 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11193 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11194 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11195 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11196 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11197 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11198
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011199 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11200 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11201 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11202 they were received.
11203
11204 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11205 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11206 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11207 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11208 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11209
11210 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11211 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11212 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11213 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11214 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11215
11216 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11217 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11218 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11219
11220 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11221 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11222 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11223 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11224 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11225
11226 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11227 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11228 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11229 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11230 the client side.
11231
11232 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11233 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11234 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11235 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11236 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11237 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11238 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11239
11240 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11241 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11242 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11243 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11244 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11245 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011246 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011247
11248 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11249 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11250 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11251 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11252 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11253 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11254
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011255 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11256 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11257 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11258 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11259 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11260
11261 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11262 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11263 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11264 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11265 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11266 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11267
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011268 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011269 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011270 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11271 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11272
11273 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11274 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11275 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11276 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11277 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11278 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11279 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11280 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11281 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11282 recommended for better fairness.
11283
11284 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011286 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11287 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11288
11289 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11290 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11291 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11292 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11293 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11294 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11295 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11296 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11297 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11298 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011299
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011300 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11301 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011302 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11303 reference it.
11304
11305 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11306 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011307 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11308 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11309 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011310
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011311 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11312 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11313 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11314 something that can be ignored.
11315
11316 Example:
11317 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11318 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11319 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11320 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11321
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011322 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011323 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324
11325
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011326stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011327 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11329 no | no | yes | yes
11330
11331 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011332 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011333 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011334 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011335 server is selected.
11336
11337 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11338 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11339 the "stick-table" statement.
11340
11341 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11342 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11343 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11344 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11345
11346 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11347 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11348 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11349 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11350 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11351 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011352 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011353 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11354 rules.
11355
11356 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11357 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11358 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11359 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11360 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11361 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11362 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11363
11364 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11365 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11366 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11367 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11368
11369 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11370 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11371 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11372 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11373 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11374 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011375 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11376 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11377 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11378 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11379 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11380 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11381 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11382 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11383 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011384
11385 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11386
11387 Example :
11388 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11389 backend https
11390 mode tcp
11391 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011392 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011393 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011394
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011395 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11396 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11397
11398 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11399 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11400 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11401
11402 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11403 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011404
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011405 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11406 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11407 # at offset 44.
11408
11409 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11410 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11411
11412 # Learn on response if server hello.
11413 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011414
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011415 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11416 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11417
11418 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11419 extraction.
11420
11421
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011422tcp-check comment <string>
11423 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11424 it fails.
11425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11426 yes | no | yes | yes
11427
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011428 Arguments :
11429 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11430 rule fails.
11431
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011432 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11433 user-friendly error reporting.
11434
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011435 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11436 "tcp-check expect".
11437
11438
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011439tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11440 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011441 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011442 Opens a new connection
11443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011444 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011445
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011446 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011447 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11448
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011449 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011450 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011451
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011452 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011453 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11454 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011455 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011456
11457 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011458
11459 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11460
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011461 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11462
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011463 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11464
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011465 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11466
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011467 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11468 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11469 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11470 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11471
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011472 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11473 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11474 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11475 haproxy -vv.
11476
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011477 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011478
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011479 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11480 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11481 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11482
11483 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11484 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11485 of the sequence.
11486
11487 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11488 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11489 do.
11490
11491 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11492 unset-var or comment rules.
11493
11494 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011495 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11496 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11497 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11498 option tcp-check
11499 tcp-check connect
11500 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11501 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11502 tcp-check send \r\n
11503 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11504 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11505 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11506 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11507 tcp-check send \r\n
11508 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11509 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11510
11511 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11512 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011513 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011514 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11515 tcp-check connect port 143
11516 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11517 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11518
11519 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11520
11521
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011522tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011523 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011524 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011525 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011528 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011529
11530 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011531 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11532
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011533 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11534 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11535 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11536 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11537 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11538 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11539 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11540 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11541 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11542 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11543
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011544 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011545 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11546 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011547 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11548 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11549 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11550
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011551 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11552 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11553 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011554 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11555 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011556 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11557 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011558 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11559 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011560 By default "L7OK" is used.
11561
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011562 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11563 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011564 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11565 supported :
11566 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11567 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011568 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11569 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11570 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11571 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11572 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011573
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011574 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011575 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011576 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11577 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11578 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11579 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011580 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11581
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011582 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11583 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11584 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11585 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11586
11587 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11588 informational message reported in logs if an error
11589 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11590 log-format string.
11591
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011592 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11593 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11594 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11595 followed by some converters.
11596
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011597 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11598 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11599 with the usual backslash ('\').
11600 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011601 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011602 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11603 used upper or lower case.
11604
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011605 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11606
11607 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11608 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11609 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11610 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11611 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11612 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11613 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11614 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11615
11616 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11617 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11618 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11619 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11620 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11621 expression.
11622
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011623 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11624 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11625 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11626 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11627 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11628 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11629
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011630 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11631 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11632 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11633 this exact hexadecimal string.
11634 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11635
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011636 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11637 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11638 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11639 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11640 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11641 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11642 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11643 size.
11644
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011645 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11646 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11647 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11648 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11649 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11650 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11651 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11652 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11653 in a binary string before matching the response's
11654 buffer.
11655
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011656 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011657 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011658 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11659 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11660 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11661 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11662 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11663 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11664 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11665 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11666 the null character.
11667
11668 Examples :
11669 # perform a POP check
11670 option tcp-check
11671 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11672
11673 # perform an IMAP check
11674 option tcp-check
11675 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11676
11677 # look for the redis master server
11678 option tcp-check
11679 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011680 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011681 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11682 tcp-check expect string role:master
11683 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11684 tcp-check expect string +OK
11685
11686
11687 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011688 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689
11690
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011691tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11692tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11693 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11694 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011697
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011698 Arguments :
11699 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11700
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011701 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11702 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011703
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011704 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11705 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011706
11707 Examples :
11708 # look for the redis master server
11709 option tcp-check
11710 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11711 tcp-check expect string role:master
11712
11713 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011714 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011715
11716
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011717tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11718tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11719 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11720 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011723
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011724 Arguments :
11725 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011726
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011727 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11728 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011729
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011730 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11731 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11732 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011733
11734 Examples :
11735 # redis check in binary
11736 option tcp-check
11737 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11738 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11739
11740
11741 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011742 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011743
11744
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011745tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011746 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011748 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011750 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011751 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11752 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11753 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11754 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11755 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11757 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11758 and '-'.
11759
11760 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11761
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011762 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011763 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11764
11765
11766tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011767 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011769 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011770
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011771 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011772 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11773 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11774 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11775 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11776 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11777 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11778 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11779 and '-'.
11780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011781 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011782 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11783
11784
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011785tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11786 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11788 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011789 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011790 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11791 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011792
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011793 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011794
11795 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11796 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011797 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11798 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11799 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11800 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11801 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11802 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011803
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011804 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11805 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11806 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11807 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011808
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011809 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011810 - accept :
11811 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11812 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11813 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011814
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011815 - reject :
11816 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11817 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11818 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11819 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11820 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11821 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11822 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11823 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11824 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11825 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11826 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011827 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011828
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011829 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11830 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11831 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11832 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11833 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11834 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11835 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11836 hosts.
11837
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011838 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11839 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11840 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11841 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11842 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11843 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11844 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11845 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11846
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011847 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11848 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11849 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11850 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11851 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11852 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11853 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11854 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11855 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011856 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11857 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011858
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011859 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011860 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011861 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11862 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11863 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011864 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011865 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011866 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11867 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11868 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11869 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11870 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11871 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11872 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011875 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011877 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011878 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11879 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11880 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011882 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11883 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11884 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11885 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011887 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11888 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11889 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11890 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11891 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011892 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11893 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11894 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11895 layer7 information is extracted.
11896
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011897 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11898 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11899 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11900 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11901 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011902
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011903 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11904 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11905 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11906 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11907
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011908 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11909 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11910 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11911 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11912
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011913 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11914 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11915 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11916 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11917 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011918
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011919 - set-src <expr> :
11920 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11921 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11922 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011923 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011925 Arguments:
11926 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11927 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011928
11929 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011930 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11931
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011932 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11933 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011934
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011935 - set-src-port <expr> :
11936 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11937 expression.
11938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011939 Arguments:
11940 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11941 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011942
11943 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011944 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11945
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011946 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11947 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11948 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011949
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011950 - set-dst <expr> :
11951 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11952 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11953 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11954 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11955 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11956
11957 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11958 followed by some converters.
11959
11960 Example:
11961
11962 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11963 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11964
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011965 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11966 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11967
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011968 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11969 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11970 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11971 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11972
11973
11974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11975 followed by some converters.
11976
11977 Example:
11978
11979 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11980
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011981 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11982 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11983 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11984
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011985 - "silent-drop" :
11986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011987 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011988 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11989 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11990 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11991 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11992 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011993 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11994 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011995 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11996 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011997 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011998 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11999 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12000 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12001 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012003 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12004 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12005 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012007 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12008 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12009 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012011 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012012 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012013 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012015 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12016 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12017 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012019 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012020 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12021 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012022
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012023 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12024
12025 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12026
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012027 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12028
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012029 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012030
12031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012032tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12033 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012035 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012036 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012037 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12038 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012040 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012041
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012043 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12044 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012045 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12046 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012048 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12049 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12050 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12051 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012052 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12053 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12054 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12055 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12056 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12057 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012058 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012059 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012061 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12062 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12063 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12064 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012065
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012066 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012067 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012068 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012069 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12070 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012071 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012072 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012073 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012074 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012075 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012076 - set-dst <expr>
12077 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012078 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012079 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012080 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012081 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012083 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012085 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12086 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012087 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12088 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012089
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012090 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12091 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12092 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12093 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12094 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12095 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012097 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012098 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12099 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012100
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012101 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12102 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12103 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12104 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12105 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12106 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012108 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012109 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12110 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12111 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12112 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12113 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12114 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12115 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12116 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12117 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12118 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012119
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012120 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012121 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12122 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12123 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012124
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012125 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12126 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12127
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012128 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012129 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12130 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012131
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012132 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12133 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012134 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012135 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12136 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012137 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012138 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012139 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012140 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12141 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012143 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12144 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012145
12146 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12147 followed by some converters.
12148
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012149 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12150 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12151 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12152 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12153 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12154 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12155 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012156 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012157 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12158 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12159
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012160 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12161
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012162 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12163 <var-name>.
12164
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012165 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12166 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12167 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12168 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12169 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12170
12171 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12172 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12173 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12174 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12175 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12176 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12177 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12178 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12179 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12180 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12181 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12182
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012183 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12184 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12185 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12186 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12187 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12188
12189 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12190
12191 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12192
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012193 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12194 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12195 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12196 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12197 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12198 evaluated.
12199
12200 Example:
12201 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12202
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012203 Example:
12204
12205 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012206 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012207
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012208 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012209 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012210 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012211 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12212 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012213 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012214 tcp-request content reject
12215
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012216 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12217 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12218 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12219 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12220 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12221 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12222 ...
12223 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12224
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012225 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012226 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12227 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12228 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012229 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012230
12231 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12232 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12233 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012234 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012235 tcp-request content reject
12236
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012237 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012238 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012239 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012240 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012241 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12242 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012243
12244 Example:
12245 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12246 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012247 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012249 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012250 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012251
12252 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012253 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012254 # protecting all our sites
12255 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012256 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12257 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012258 ...
12259 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12260
12261 backend http_dynamic
12262 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012263 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012264 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012265 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012266 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012267 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012268 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012270 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012271
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012272 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12273 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
12275
12276tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12277 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012279 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012280 Arguments :
12281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12283 as explained at the top of this document.
12284
12285 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12286 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12287 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12288 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12289 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12290
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012291 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12292 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12293 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12294 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12295
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012296 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12297 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012298 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012299 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012300 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12301 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12302 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12303 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012304
12305 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12306 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12307 it pass through unaffected.
12308
12309 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12310 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12311 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012312 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012313 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12314 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012315 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12316 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12317 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012318
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012319 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012320 "timeout client".
12321
12322
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012323tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12324 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12326 no | no | yes | yes
12327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012328 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12329 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012330
12331 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012333 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012334 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12335 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012336 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12337 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012338
12339 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12340
12341 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12342 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12343 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12344 inserted.
12345
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012346 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012347 - accept :
12348 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12349 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12350 the rules evaluation.
12351
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012352 - close :
12353 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12354 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12355 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12356 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12357 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12358 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012359 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012360 protocols.
12361
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012362 - reject :
12363 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12364 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012365 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012366
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012367 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12368 Sets a variable.
12369
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012370 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12371 Unsets a variable.
12372
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012373 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12374 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12375 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12376 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12377
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012378 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12379 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12380 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12381 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12382
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012383 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12384 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12385 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12386 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12387 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012388
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012389 - "silent-drop" :
12390 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012391 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012392 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12393 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12394 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12395 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12396 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012397 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12398 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012399 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12400 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012401 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012402 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12403 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12404 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12405 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12406
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012407 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12408 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12409
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012410 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12411 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12412 for changing the default action to a reject.
12413
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012414 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12415 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12416 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12417 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012418 period.
12419
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012420 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12421 declared inline.
12422
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012423 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12424 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012425 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012426 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12427 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012428 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012429 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012430 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012431 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12432 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012433 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012434 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12435 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012436
12437 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12438 followed by some converters.
12439
12440 Example:
12441
12442 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12443
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012444 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12445 <var-name>.
12446
12447 Example:
12448
12449 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12450
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012451 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12452 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12453 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12454 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12455 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12456
12457 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12458
12459 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12460
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012461 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12462
12463 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12464
12465
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012466tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12467 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12469 no | yes | yes | no
12470 Arguments :
12471 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12472 below.
12473
12474 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012476 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012477 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12478 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12479 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12480 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12481 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12482 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12483 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012485 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12486 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12487 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12488 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12489 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12490 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12491 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12492 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12493 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12494 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12495 instead.
12496
12497 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12498 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12499 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12500 rules which may be inserted.
12501
12502 Several types of actions are supported :
12503 - accept : the request is accepted
12504 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12505 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12506 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012507 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012508 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012509 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012510 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012511 - silent-drop
12512
12513 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12514 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12515 sections for a complete description.
12516
12517 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12518 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12519 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12520
12521 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12522 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12523 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12524 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12525 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12526
12527 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12528 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12529
12530 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12531 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12532 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12533
12534 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12535 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12536 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12537
12538 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12539 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12540 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12541
12542 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12543 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12544 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12545
12546 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12547
12548 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12549
12550
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012551tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12552 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12554 no | no | yes | yes
12555 Arguments :
12556 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12557 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12558 as explained at the top of this document.
12559
12560 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12561
12562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012563timeout check <timeout>
12564 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12565 established.
12566
12567 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12568 yes | no | yes | yes
12569 Arguments:
12570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12572 as explained at the top of this document.
12573
12574 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12575 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012576 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012577 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012578 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12579 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12580 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012581
12582 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12583 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12584
12585 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12586 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012587 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012588
12589 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12590 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12591 forget about it.
12592
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012593 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12594 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012595
12596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012597timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012598 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12600 yes | yes | yes | no
12601 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012602 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012603 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12604 as explained at the top of this document.
12605
12606 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12607 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12608 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012609 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12610 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12611 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12612 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012613 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12614 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12615 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012616 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012617 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012618 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12619 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012620 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12621 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012622
12623 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12624 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12625 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12626 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012627 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012628 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12629
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012630 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012631
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012632 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012634
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012635timeout client-fin <timeout>
12636 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12638 yes | yes | yes | no
12639 Arguments :
12640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12642 as explained at the top of this document.
12643
12644 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12645 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12646 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12647 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12648 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12649 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12650 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012651 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12652 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12653 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012654
12655 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12656 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12657 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12658
12659 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12660
12661
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012662timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012663 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12665 yes | no | yes | yes
12666 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012667 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012668 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12669 as explained at the top of this document.
12670
12671 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012672 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012673 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012674 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012675 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12676 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012677
12678 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12679 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12680 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12681 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012682 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12684
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012685 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012687
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012688timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12689 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12691 yes | yes | yes | yes
12692 Arguments :
12693 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12694 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12695 as explained at the top of this document.
12696
12697 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12698 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12699 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12700 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12701 once the request has started to present itself.
12702
12703 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12704 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12705 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12706 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12707 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12708
12709 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12710 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12711 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12712 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12713
12714 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12715 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012716 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012717 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12718 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012719 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012720
12721 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12722 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12723 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12724 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12725
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012726 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12727 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012728 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12729
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012730 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12731
12732
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012733timeout http-request <timeout>
12734 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012737 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012738 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012739 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12740 as explained at the top of this document.
12741
12742 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12743 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12744 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12745 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12746 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12747 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12748 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012749 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12750 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12751 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12752 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012753 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012754 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12755 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012756
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012757 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12758 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12759 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12760 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12761 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012762 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012763
12764 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12765 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012766 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012767 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12768 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12769
12770 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012771 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12772 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12773 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012774
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012775 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012776 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012777
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012778
12779timeout queue <timeout>
12780 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12782 yes | no | yes | yes
12783 Arguments :
12784 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12785 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12786 as explained at the top of this document.
12787
12788 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12789 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12790 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12791 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12792 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12793
12794 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12795 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12796 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12797 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12798
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012799 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012800
12801
12802timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012803 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12805 yes | no | yes | yes
12806 Arguments :
12807 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12809 as explained at the top of this document.
12810
12811 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12812 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12813 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12814 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12815 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12816 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12817 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12818
12819 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12820 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12821 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12822 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12823 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012824 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012825 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012826 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12827 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012828 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12829 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012830
12831 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12832 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12833 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12834 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012835 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012836 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12837
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012838 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012839
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012840
12841timeout server-fin <timeout>
12842 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12844 yes | no | yes | yes
12845 Arguments :
12846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12848 as explained at the top of this document.
12849
12850 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12851 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12852 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12853 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12854 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12855 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12856 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12857 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12858 situations, it should not be needed.
12859
12860 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12861 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12862 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12863
12864 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12865
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012866
12867timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012868 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12870 yes | yes | yes | yes
12871 Arguments :
12872 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12873 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12874 as explained at the top of this document.
12875
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012876 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12877 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12878 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012879
12880 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12881 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12882 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12883 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012884 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012886 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012887
12888
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012889timeout tunnel <timeout>
12890 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12892 yes | no | yes | yes
12893 Arguments :
12894 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12895 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12896 as explained at the top of this document.
12897
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012898 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012899 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12900 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12901 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012902 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12903 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012904 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12905 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12906 specified.
12907
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012908 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12909 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12910 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12911 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12912 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12913 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12914 state.
12915
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012916 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12917 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12918 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12919 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012920 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012921
12922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12924 forget about it.
12925
12926 Example :
12927 defaults http
12928 option http-server-close
12929 timeout connect 5s
12930 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012931 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012932 timeout server 30s
12933 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12934
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012935 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012936
12937
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012938transparent (deprecated)
12939 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012941 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012942 Arguments : none
12943
12944 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12945 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12946 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12947 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12948 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12949 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12950 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12951 appropriate server.
12952
12953 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12954
12955 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12956 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12957
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012958 See also: "option transparent"
12959
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012960unique-id-format <string>
12961 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12963 yes | yes | yes | no
12964 Arguments :
12965 <string> is a log-format string.
12966
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012967 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12968 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12969 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12970 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012971
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012972 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12973 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12974 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12975 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12976 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12977 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12978 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12979 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012980
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012981 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12982 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012983
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012984 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012985
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012986 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012987
12988 will generate:
12989
12990 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12991
12992 See also: "unique-id-header"
12993
12994unique-id-header <name>
12995 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12997 yes | yes | yes | no
12998 Arguments :
12999 <name> is the name of the header.
13000
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013001 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13002 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013003
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013004 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013005
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013006 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013007 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13008
13009 will generate:
13010
13011 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13012
13013 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013015use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013016 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13018 no | yes | yes | no
13019 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013020 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13021 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013022
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013023 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13024 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013025
13026 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13027 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13028 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013029 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013030 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013031 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13032 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013033
13034 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13035 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13036 assign the backend.
13037
13038 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13039 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13040 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13041 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13042 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13043 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13044
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013045 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013046 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013047 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13048 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13049 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13050
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013051 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13052 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13053 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13054 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13055 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13056 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13057 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13058 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13059 cannot be forced from the request.
13060
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013061 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013062 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13063 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13064
13065 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13066 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013067
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013068use-fcgi-app <name>
13069 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13071 no | no | yes | yes
13072 Arguments :
13073 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13074
13075 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013076
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013077use-server <server> if <condition>
13078use-server <server> unless <condition>
13079 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13081 no | no | yes | yes
13082 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013083 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13084 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013085
13086 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13087
13088 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13089 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13090 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13091
13092 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13093 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13094 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13095 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13096 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13097 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13098 matches will assign the server.
13099
13100 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13101 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13102 with the next rules until one matches.
13103
13104 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13105 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13106 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13107 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13108
13109 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13110 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13111 stripped.
13112
13113 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13114 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013115 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13116 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13117 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013118
13119 Example :
13120 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13121 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13122 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13123 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013124 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013125 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013126 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013127 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13128 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13129
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013130 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13131 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13132 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13133 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013134 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013135 and we fall back to load balancing.
13136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013137 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131405. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013141--------------------------
13142
13143The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13144depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13145settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13146written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13147described in this section.
13148
13149
131505.1. Bind options
13151-----------------
13152
13153The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13154as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13155no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13156parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13157while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13158provided immediately after the setting name.
13159
13160The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13161
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013162accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13163 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13164 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13165 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13166 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13167 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13168 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13169 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13170 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13171 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013172 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13173 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13174 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013176accept-proxy
13177 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013178 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13179 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013180 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13181 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13182 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13183 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013184 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013185 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13186 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013187 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13188 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013189
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013190allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013191 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013192 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013193 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013194 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13195 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013196
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013197alpn <protocols>
13198 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13199 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13200 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013201 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013202 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013203 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13204 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13205 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13206 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13207 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13208 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13209 preference, like below :
13210
13211 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013212
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013213backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013214 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013215 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13216
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013217curves <curves>
13218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13219 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13220 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13221 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13222 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13223 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13224
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013225ecdhe <named curve>
13226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013227 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13228 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013229
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013230ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13232 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13233 client's certificate.
13234
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013235ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13237 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13238 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13239 error is ignored.
13240
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013241ca-sign-file <cafile>
13242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13243 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13244 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13245 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13246 'generate-certificates' for details.
13247
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013248ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13250 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13251 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13252 'generate-certificates' for details.
13253
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013254ca-verify-file <cafile>
13255 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13256 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13257 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13258 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13259 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013261ciphers <ciphers>
13262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13263 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013264 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013265 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013266 information and recommendations see e.g.
13267 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13268 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13269 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13270
13271ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13273 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13274 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13275 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013276 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13277 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013278
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013279crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13281 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13282 to verify client's certificate.
13283
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013284crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13286 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13287 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13288 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13289 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013290 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13291 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013292
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013293 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13294 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13295
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013296 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13297 are loaded.
13298
13299 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013300 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13301 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13302 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13303 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13304 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13305 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13306 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013307 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013308
13309 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13310 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13311 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13312 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013313 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13314 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013315
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013316 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013317
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013318 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013319 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13321 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013322 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13323 clients).
13324
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013325 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13326 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13327 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13328 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13329 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13330 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13331 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13332 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13333 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13334 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13335 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13336 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13337 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13338
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013339 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13340 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13341 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13342 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13343 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13344
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013345 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13346 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13347 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13348 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013349
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013350 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13351 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13352 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013353
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013354crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013357 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013358 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013359
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013360crt-list <file>
13361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013362 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13363 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013364
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013365 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13366
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013367 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13368 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13369 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13370 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13371 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013372
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013373 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013374 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13375 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13376 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13377 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13378 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013379 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13380 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13381 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013382
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013383 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13384 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13385 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013386
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013387 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13388
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013389 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13390 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13391 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13392 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13393 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13394 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13395 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13396 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013397
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013398 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013399 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013400 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013401 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013402 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013403 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013405defer-accept
13406 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13407 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13408 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013409 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013410 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13411 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13412 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13413 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13414 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13415 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13416 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13417
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013418expose-fd listeners
13419 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13420 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013421 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13422 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013423 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013424
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013425force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013426 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013427 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013428 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013429 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013430
13431force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013433 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013434 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013435
13436force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013438 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013439 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013440
13441force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013443 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013444 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013445
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013446force-tlsv13
13447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13448 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013449 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013450
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013451generate-certificates
13452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13453 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13454 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13455 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13456 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13457 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13458 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13459 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13460 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13461 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13462 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13463
13464 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13465 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013466 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013467 certificate is used many times.
13468
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013469gid <gid>
13470 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13471 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13472 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13473 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13474 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13475
13476group <group>
13477 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13478 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13479 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13480 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13481 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13482
13483id <id>
13484 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13485 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13486 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13487 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13488
13489interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013490 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13491 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13492 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13493 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13494 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13495 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013496 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13497 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13498 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13499 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13500 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13501 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013502
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013503level <level>
13504 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13505 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13506 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013508 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13509 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13510 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013511 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013512 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013513 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013514 all counters).
13515
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013516severity-output <format>
13517 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13518 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13519 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13520 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13521 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13522 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13523 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13524 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13525 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13526 rfc5424 convention.
13527
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013528maxconn <maxconn>
13529 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13530 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13531 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13532 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13533 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13534 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13535 eat all memory.
13536
13537mode <mode>
13538 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13539 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13540 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13541 UNIX sockets.
13542
13543mss <maxseg>
13544 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13545 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13546 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13547 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13548 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13549 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13550 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13551 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13552 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13553 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13554 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13555
13556name <name>
13557 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13558 page.
13559
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013560namespace <name>
13561 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13562 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13563 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13564 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13565
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013566nice <nice>
13567 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13568 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13569 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13570 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13571 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13572 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13573 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13574 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13575 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13576 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13577 one for an RDP socket.
13578
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013579no-ca-names
13580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13581 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013582 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013583
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013584no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013586 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013587 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013588 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013589 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13590 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013591
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013592no-tls-tickets
13593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13594 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13595 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013596 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13597 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013598 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13599 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13600 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013601
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013602no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013604 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013605 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013606 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013607 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13608 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013610no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013612 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013613 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013614 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013615 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13616 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013617
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013618no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013620 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013621 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013622 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013623 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13624 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013625
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013626no-tlsv13
13627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13628 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13629 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13630 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013631 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13632 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013633
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013634npn <protocols>
13635 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13636 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13637 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013638 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013639 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013640 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13641 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13642 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13643 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13644 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013645
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013646prefer-client-ciphers
13647 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13648 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13649 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013650 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13651 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13652 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013653
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013654process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013655 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013656 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013658 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13659 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13660 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13661 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013663 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13664 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13665 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13666 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13667 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013668
13669 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13670
13671 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13672 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13673 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13674 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13675 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13676 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13677 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13678 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013679
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013680proto <name>
13681 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13682 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13683 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013684 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13685 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13686
13687 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13688 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13689 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13690 also reported (flag=HTX).
13691
13692 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13693 a bind line :
13694
13695 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13696 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13697 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13698
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013699 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013700 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013701 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013702 h2" on the bind line.
13703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013704ssl
13705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013706 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013707 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13708 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013709 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13710 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013711
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013712ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13713 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013714 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13715 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13716 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013717 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13718
13719ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013720 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13721 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13722 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13723 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013724
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013725strict-sni
13726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13727 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13728 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13729 See the "crt" option for more information.
13730
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013731tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013732 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013733 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13734 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013736 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13737 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13738 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13739 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13740 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13741 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13742 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13743
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013744tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013745 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013746 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13747 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13748 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13749 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13750 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13751 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13752 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013753 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13754 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13755 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013756
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013757tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13758 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013759 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13760 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13761 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13762 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13763 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13764 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13765 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13766 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13767 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13768 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013769 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13770 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013772transparent
13773 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13774 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13775 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13776 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13777 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13778 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13779 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13780 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13781 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13782 so check for support with your vendor.
13783
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013784v4v6
13785 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13786 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13787 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13788 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013789 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013790
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013791v6only
13792 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13793 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13794 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013795 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13796 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013797
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013798uid <uid>
13799 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13800 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13801 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13802 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13803 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13804
13805user <user>
13806 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13807 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13808 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13809 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13810 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13811
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013812verify [none|optional|required]
13813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13814 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13815 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13816 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13817 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013818 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13819 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13820 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13821 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013822
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200138235.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013824------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013826The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13827which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13828arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13829settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13830after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13831Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13832address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013834 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013835 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013836
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013837Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13838keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013840The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013841
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013842addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013843 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013844 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13845 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13846 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13847 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13848 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013849
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013850agent-check
13851 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013852 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013853 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13854 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13855 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013856
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013857 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013858 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013859 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13860 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13861 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013862
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013863 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13864 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13865 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13866 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13867 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013868
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013869 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013870 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013871
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013872 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13873 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13874 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013875
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013876 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13877 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13878 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013879
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013880 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013881 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13882 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13883 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13884 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013886 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013887
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013888 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13889 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013890
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013891 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13892 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13893 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13894 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13895 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13896 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13897 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13898 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13899 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013900
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013901 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13902 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013903 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13904 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13905 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013906 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013907
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013908 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013909 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013910
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013911agent-send <string>
13912 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13913 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13914 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13915 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13916 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13917
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013918agent-inter <delay>
13919 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13920 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13921
13922 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13923 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13924 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13925 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13926 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13927 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13928 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13929 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13930 of backends use the same servers.
13931
13932 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13933
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013934agent-addr <addr>
13935 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13936
13937 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13938 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13939 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13940 hostname, it will be resolved.
13941
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013942agent-port <port>
13943 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13944
13945 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13946
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013947allow-0rtt
13948 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013949 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13950 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013951
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013952alpn <protocols>
13953 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13954 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13955 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013956 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013957 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13958 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13959 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13960 now obsolete NPN extension.
13961 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13962 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13963
13964 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013966backup
13967 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13968 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13969 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13970 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013971 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13972 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013973
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013974ca-file <cafile>
13975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13976 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13977 server's certificate.
13978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013979check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013980 This option enables health checks on a server:
13981 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13982 considered available.
13983 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13984 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13985 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13986 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13987 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13988 set.
13989 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13990 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13991 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13992 exchanges succeed.
13993
13994 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13995 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13996 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13997 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13998 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013999 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014000 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14001
14002 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14003 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14004
14005 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14006 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14007
14008 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14009 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14010 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14011 available.
14012
14013 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14014 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14015 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14016
14017 Example:
14018 # simple tcp check
14019 backend foo
14020 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14021 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14022 backend foo
14023 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14024 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14025 backend foo
14026 option tcp-check
14027 tcp-check connect
14028 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014029
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014030check-send-proxy
14031 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14032 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14033 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14034 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14035 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14036 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14037 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14038
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014039check-alpn <protocols>
14040 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14041 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14042 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14043
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014044check-proto <name>
14045 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14046 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14047 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014048 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14049 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14050
14051 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14052 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14053 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14054 also reported (flag=HTX).
14055
14056 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14057 directive on a server line:
14058
14059 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14060 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14061 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14062 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14063
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014064 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014065 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14066 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14067
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014068check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014069 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014070 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14071 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014072
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014073check-ssl
14074 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14075 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14076 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14077 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014078 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014079 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14080 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014081 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014082 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14083 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014084
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014085check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014086 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014087 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14088 for normal traffic.
14089
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014090ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14092 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14093 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014094 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14095 information and recommendations see e.g.
14096 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14097 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14098 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014099
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014100ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14102 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14103 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14104 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014105 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14106 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14107 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014109cookie <value>
14110 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14111 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14112 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14113 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14114 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14115 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14116 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14117
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014118crl-file <crlfile>
14119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14120 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14121 to verify server's certificate.
14122
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014123crt <cert>
14124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14125 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14126 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14127 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14128 certificate request.
14129
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014130disabled
14131 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14132 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14133 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14134 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14135 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014136 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014137
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014138enabled
14139 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14140 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14141 default value.
14142 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14143 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014145error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014146 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14147 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14148 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014150 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014152fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014153 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14154 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14155 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14156
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014157force-sslv3
14158 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14159 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014160 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014161 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014162
14163force-tlsv10
14164 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014165 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014166 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014167
14168force-tlsv11
14169 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014170 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014171 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014172
14173force-tlsv12
14174 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014175 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014176 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014177
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014178force-tlsv13
14179 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14180 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014181 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014184 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14185 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14186 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014187
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014188init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14189 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14190 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014191 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014192 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14193 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14194 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14195 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14196 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14197 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14198 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14199 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14200 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014201 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014202 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14203 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14204 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14205 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14206 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14207 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014208 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014209
14210 Example:
14211 defaults
14212 # never fail on address resolution
14213 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014215inter <delay>
14216fastinter <delay>
14217downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014218 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14219 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14220 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14221 between checks depending on the server state :
14222
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014223 Server state | Interval used
14224 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14225 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14226 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14227 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14228 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14229 or yet unchecked. |
14230 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14231 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14232 | "inter" otherwise.
14233 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014235 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14236 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14237 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14238 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014239 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14240 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14241 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14242 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14243 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014244
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014245log-proto <logproto>
14246 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14247 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14248 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14249 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014251maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014252 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14253 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014254 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14255 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014256 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14257 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14258 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14259 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14260
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014261 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14262 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14263 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14264 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14265 than 50 concurrent requests.
14266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014267maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014268 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14269 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14270 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14271 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014272 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14273 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14274 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14275 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14276 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14277 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14278 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014279
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014280max-reuse <count>
14281 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14282 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14283 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14284 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14285 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14286 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14287 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14288 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014290minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014291 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14292 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14293 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14294 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14295 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14296 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014297 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014298 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014299
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014300namespace <name>
14301 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14302 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14303 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14304 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14305
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014306no-agent-check
14307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14309 default value.
14310 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14311 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14312
14313no-backup
14314 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14315 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14316 default value.
14317 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14318 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14319
14320no-check
14321 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14322 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14323 default value.
14324 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14325 "default-server" "check" setting.
14326
14327no-check-ssl
14328 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14329 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14330 default value.
14331 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14332 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14333
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014334no-send-proxy
14335 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14336 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14337 default value.
14338 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14339 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14340
14341no-send-proxy-v2
14342 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14343 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14344 default value.
14345 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14346 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14347
14348no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14349 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14350 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14351 default value.
14352 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14353 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14354
14355no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14356 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14357 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14358 default value.
14359 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14360 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14361
14362no-ssl
14363 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14364 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14365 default value.
14366 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14367 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14368
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014369 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14370 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14371 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14372
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014373no-ssl-reuse
14374 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14375 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14376 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14377 and for paranoid users.
14378
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014379no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014380 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14381 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014382 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014383
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014384 Supported in default-server: No
14385
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014386no-tls-tickets
14387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14388 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14389 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014390 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14391 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014392 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14393 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14394 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014395 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014396
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014397no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014398 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014399 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14400 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014401 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14402 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014403 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014404
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014405 Supported in default-server: No
14406
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014407no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014408 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014409 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14410 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014411 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14412 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014413 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014414
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014415 Supported in default-server: No
14416
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014417no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014418 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014419 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14420 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014421 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14422 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014423 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014424
14425 Supported in default-server: No
14426
14427no-tlsv13
14428 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14429 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14430 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14431 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14432 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014433 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014434
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014435 Supported in default-server: No
14436
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014437no-verifyhost
14438 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14439 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14440 default value.
14441 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14442 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014443
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014444no-tfo
14445 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14446 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14447 default value.
14448 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14449 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14450
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014451non-stick
14452 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14453 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14454 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14455
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014456npn <protocols>
14457 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14458 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14459 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014460 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014461 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14462 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14463 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014465observe <mode>
14466 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14467 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14468 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14469 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14470 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14471 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014472 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014473
14474 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014476on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014477 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14478 Currently, four modes are available:
14479 - fastinter: force fastinter
14480 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14481 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14482 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14483 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14484
14485 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14486
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014487on-marked-down <action>
14488 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14489 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014490 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14491 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14492 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14493 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14494 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14495 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14496 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14497 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014498
14499 Actions are disabled by default
14500
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014501on-marked-up <action>
14502 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14503 Currently one action is available:
14504 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14505 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14506 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14507 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014508 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14509 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014510 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14511 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14512
14513 Actions are disabled by default
14514
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014515pool-low-conn <max>
14516 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14517 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14518 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14519 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14520 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14521 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14522 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14523 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14524 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14525 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014526 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14527 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14528 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14529 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014530
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014531pool-max-conn <max>
14532 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14533 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14534 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14535 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14536 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14537 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14538
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014539pool-purge-delay <delay>
14540 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014541 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014542 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014544port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014545 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014546 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14547 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14548 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14549 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14550 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014551
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014552proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014553 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14554 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14555 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014556 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14557 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14558
14559 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14560 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14561 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14562 also reported (flag=HTX).
14563
14564 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14565 a server line :
14566
14567 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14568 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14569 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14570 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14571
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014572 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014573 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014575redir <prefix>
14576 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14577 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14578 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14579 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14580 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14581 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14582 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14583 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014584 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014585 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014586 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14587 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14588 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14589 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14590
14591 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014593rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014594 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14595 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14596 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14597
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014598resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14599 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14600 server.
14601
14602 Available options:
14603
14604 * allow-dup-ip
14605 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14606 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14607 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14608 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14609 For such case, simply enable this option.
14610 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14611
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014612 * ignore-weight
14613 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14614 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14615 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14616
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014617 * prevent-dup-ip
14618 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14619 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14620 same fqdn.
14621 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14622
14623 Example:
14624 backend b_myapp
14625 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14626 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14627 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14628
14629 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14630 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14631 it
14632 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14633 different address
14634
14635 Default value: not set
14636
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014637resolve-prefer <family>
14638 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14639 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14640 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14641 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14642
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014643 Default value: ipv6
14644
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014645 Example:
14646
14647 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014648
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014649resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014650 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014651 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014652 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14654 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014655 configured network, another address is selected.
14656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014657 Example:
14658
14659 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014660
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014661resolvers <id>
14662 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14663 hostname.
14664
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014665 Example:
14666
14667 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014668
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014669 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014670
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014671send-proxy
14672 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14673 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14674 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14675 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014676 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14677 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14678 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14679 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14680 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14681 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14682 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14683 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14684 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14685 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014686 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14687 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014688
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014689send-proxy-v2
14690 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14691 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14692 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14693 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014694 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14695 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14696 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14697 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014698
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014699proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014700 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14701 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14702
14703 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14704 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14705 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14706 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14707 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14708 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14709 connection is supported).
14710 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14711 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14712 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14713 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14714 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14715 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14716 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014717
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014718send-proxy-v2-ssl
14719 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14720 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14721 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14722 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14723 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14724 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14725 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014726 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14727 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014728
14729send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14730 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14731 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14732 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14733 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14734 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14735 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14736 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14737 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014738 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14739 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014741slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014742 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14743 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14744 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14745 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14746 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14747 parameters :
14748
14749 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14750 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14751
14752 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14753 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14754 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14755 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14756
14757 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14758 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14759 seen as failed.
14760
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014761sni <expression>
14762 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14763 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14764 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14765 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014766 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14767 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014768 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014769 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14770 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014771
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014772source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014773source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014774source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014775 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14776 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14777 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14778 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14779
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014780 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14781 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14782 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14783 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14784 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14785 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14786 server.
14787
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014788 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14789 specifying the source address without port(s).
14790
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014791ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014792 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14793 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14794 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14795 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14796 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14797 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014798 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14799 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014800
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014801ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14802 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14803 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14804 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14805
14806ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14807 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14808 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14809 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14810
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014811ssl-reuse
14812 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14813 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14814 default value.
14815 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14816 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14817
14818stick
14819 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14820 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14821 default value.
14822 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14823 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014824
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014825socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014826 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014827 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14828 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14829
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014830tcp-ut <delay>
14831 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14832 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14833 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014834 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014835 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14836 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14837 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14838 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14839 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14840 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14841 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14842 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14843 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14844
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014845tfo
14846 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14847 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14848 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14849 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14850 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014851 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014853track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014854 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14855 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14856 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14857 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014858 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14859
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014860tls-tickets
14861 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14862 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14863 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014864 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14865 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14866 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014867 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014868 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014869
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014870verify [none|required]
14871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014872 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014873 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14874 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014875 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014876 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14877 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14878 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14879 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14880 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14881 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14882 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14883 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014884
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014885verifyhost <hostname>
14886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014887 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14888 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14889 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14890 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14891 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14892 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14893 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14894 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014896weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014897 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14898 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14899 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014900 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14901 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14902 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14903 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14904 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14905 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014906
14907
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149085.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14909-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014910
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014911HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14912using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014913configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014914This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14915can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14916workload.
14917This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14918resolution at run time.
14919Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14920carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14921
14922
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149235.3.1. Global overview
14924----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014925
14926As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14927different steps of the process life:
14928
14929 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14930 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14931 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14932
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014933 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14934 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014935
14936A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14937 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14938 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14939 resolution to know this new IP.
14940
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014941When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014942HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014943SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14944from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14945will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14946will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014947
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014948A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014949 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014950 first valid response.
14951
14952 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14953 servers return an error.
14954
14955
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149565.3.2. The resolvers section
14957----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014958
14959This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014960HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14961contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014962
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014963When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14964uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14965is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14966answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14967
14968When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014969used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014970
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014971 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14972 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14973 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014974
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014975 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14976 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014977
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014978 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14979 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14980 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014981
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014982For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14983following scenarios are possible:
14984
14985 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14986 ignored
14987
14988 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14989 applied
14990
14991 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14992 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14993
14994 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14995 retries the query with a new type
14996
14997 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14998 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014999
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015000As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15001a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015002<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015003
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015004
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015005resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015006 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015007
15008A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15009
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015010accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015011 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015012 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015013 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15014 by RFC 6891)
15015
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015016 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15017 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15018 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15019 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15020 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15021 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015022
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015023nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15024 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15025 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15026 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15027 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15028 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15029 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15030 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15031 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15032 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015033 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15034
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015035parse-resolv-conf
15036 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15037 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15038 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15039
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015040hold <status> <period>
15041 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15042 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015043 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015044 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015045 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15046 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15047 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15048
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015049 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015050
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015051resolve_retries <nb>
15052 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15053 giving up.
15054 Default value: 3
15055
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015056 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15057 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15058 type.
15059
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015060timeout <event> <time>
15061 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15062 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15063 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015064 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15065 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015066 Default value: 1s
15067 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015068 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015069 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015070 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15071 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15072
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015073 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015074
15075 resolvers mydns
15076 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15077 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015078 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015079 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015080 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015081 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015082 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015083 hold other 30s
15084 hold refused 30s
15085 hold nx 30s
15086 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015087 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015088 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015089
15090
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200150916. Cache
15092---------
15093
15094HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15095(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15096RAM.
15097
15098The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15099this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15100
15101If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15102independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15103when we try to allocate a new one.
15104
15105The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15106
15107It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15108"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15109for more details.
15110
15111When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15112replaced by "<CACHE>".
15113
15114
151156.1. Limitation
15116----------------
15117
15118The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15119
15120- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015121- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15122 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15123 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015124- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15125- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015126- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15127 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15128 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015129- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15130 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015131- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15132 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15133 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015134
15135- If the request is not a GET
15136- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15137- If the request contains an Authorization header
15138
15139
151406.2. Setup
15141-----------
15142
15143To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15144the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15145
15146
151476.2.1. Cache section
15148---------------------
15149
15150cache <name>
15151 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15152 size of cache is mandatory.
15153
15154total-max-size <megabytes>
15155 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15156 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15157
15158max-object-size <bytes>
15159 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15160 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15161 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15162
15163max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015164 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015165 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15166 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15167 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15168 default.
15169
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015170process-vary <on/off>
15171 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015172 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15173 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15174 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015175 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015176
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015177max-secondary-entries <number>
15178 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15179 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15180 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15181
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015182
151836.2.2. Proxy section
15184---------------------
15185
15186http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15187 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15188 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15189 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15190 after this one.
15191
15192http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15193 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15194 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15195 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15196 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15197
15198
15199Example:
15200
15201 backend bck1
15202 mode http
15203
15204 http-request cache-use foobar
15205 http-response cache-store foobar
15206 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15207
15208 cache foobar
15209 total-max-size 4
15210 max-age 240
15211
15212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152137. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15214----------------------------------
15215
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015216HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15218The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15219these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15220but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15221data called patterns.
15222
15223
152247.1. ACL basics
15225---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015226
15227The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15228content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15229from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15230simple :
15231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015233 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15235 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15238adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015239
15240In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015243
15244This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15245Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15246and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015247an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15248conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15249as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15250are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015251
15252ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15253'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15254which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15255
15256There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15257performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15260specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15261this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015262methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15263ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264
15265Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15266 - boolean
15267 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15268 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15269 - string
15270 - data block
15271
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015272Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15273converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15274would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15275The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15276which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15277
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015278Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15279keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15280fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15281which are summarized in the table below :
15282
15283 +---------------------+-----------------+
15284 | Sample or converter | Default |
15285 | output type | matching method |
15286 +---------------------+-----------------+
15287 | boolean | bool |
15288 +---------------------+-----------------+
15289 | integer | int |
15290 +---------------------+-----------------+
15291 | ip | ip |
15292 +---------------------+-----------------+
15293 | string | str |
15294 +---------------------+-----------------+
15295 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15296 +---------------------+-----------------+
15297
15298Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15299matching method, see below.
15300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15302 - boolean
15303 - integer or integer range
15304 - IP address / network
15305 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15306 - regular expression
15307 - hex block
15308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015309The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15310
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015311 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15312 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015314 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015315 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015316 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015317 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15320read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15321if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15322lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15323will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15324beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15325a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15326lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15327exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15328
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015329The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15330parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15331ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15332a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15333check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15334
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015335The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15336socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15337file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15340loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15341
15342 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15343
15344In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15345the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15346case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15347as well.
15348
15349The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15350sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15351do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15352methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15353is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015354obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15356default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15357that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15358string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15359
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015360The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15361By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15362string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15363resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15364server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015365waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015366flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15367function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15370sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15371be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015372
15373 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15374 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15376 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15377 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15378 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015379
15380 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15381 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015383
15384 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015385 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015386
15387 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015389
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015391 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15392
15393 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15394 binary or string samples.
15395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15397 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15400 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15401 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15404 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15407 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15410 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15413 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015414 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15417 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15418 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015419
15420For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15421request, it is possible to do :
15422
15423 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15424
15425In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15426buffer, one would use the following acl :
15427
15428 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15429
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015430On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15431possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15432
15433 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15436criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15437method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15438to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15439criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15440the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015443the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15444For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15447 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15448 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15449 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015450
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015451
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015452The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15453types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15454combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15455brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15456default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458 +-------------------------------------------------+
15459 | Input sample type |
15460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015461 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15463 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015465 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015467 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015469 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015471 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015473 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015475 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015477 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015479 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015481 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015483 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015485 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15487 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15488 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015489
15490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154917.1.1. Matching booleans
15492------------------------
15493
15494In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15495Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15496When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15497that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15498
15499Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15500return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15501"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155047.1.2. Matching integers
15505------------------------
15506
15507Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15508enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15509to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15510
15511Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15512matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15513lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015514
15515For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15516unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15517representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15518
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015519As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15520two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15521instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15522ranges and operators.
15523
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015524For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015525operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15526Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15527of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015529Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015530
15531 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15532 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15533 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15534 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15535 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015537For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015538
15539 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15540
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015541This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15542
15543 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155467.1.3. Matching strings
15547-----------------------
15548
15549String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15550different forms :
15551
15552 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015553 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554
15555 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015556 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557
15558 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15559 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15560
15561 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15562 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15563
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015564 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15566 matches.
15567
15568 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15569 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15570 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015571
15572String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15573exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15574characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15575string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15576to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015577before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015578
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015579Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15580(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15581Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15582
15583Example:
15584 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15585 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155887.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15589---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015590
15591Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15592they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15593possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15594passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15595the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015596the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15597match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015598
15599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156007.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15601-------------------------------------
15602
15603It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15604not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15605a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15606to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15607digits may be used upper or lower case.
15608
15609Example :
15610 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15611 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15612
15613
156147.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15615---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015616
15617IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15618netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15619within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015620host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015621difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15622at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15623does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15624parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015625
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015626The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15627abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15628
15629 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15630 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15631 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15632 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15633 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15634 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15635 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15636 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15637
15638Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15639192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15640
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015641IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15642Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15643trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15644IPv6 patterns.
15645
15646HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15647following situations :
15648 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15649 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15650 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15651 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15652 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15653 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15654 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15655 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15656 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15657 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659
156607.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15661----------------------------------
15662
15663Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15664combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15665
15666 - AND (implicit)
15667 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15668 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15675indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15678"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15679requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15680is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15681
15682 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015683 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15684 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15685 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686
15687To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15688and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15689
15690 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15691 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15692 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15693 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015695 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15697 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15698 use_backend www if host_www
15699
15700It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15701expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15702be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15703the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15704
15705 The following rule :
15706
15707 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015708 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709
15710 Can also be written that way :
15711
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015712 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713
15714It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15715to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15716simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15717sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15718good use is the following :
15719
15720 With named ACLs :
15721
15722 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15723 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15724 monitor fail if site_dead
15725
15726 With anonymous ACLs :
15727
15728 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15729
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015730See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15731keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732
15733
157347.3. Fetching samples
15735---------------------
15736
15737Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15738against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15739sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15740ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15741of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15742available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15743
15744This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15745Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15746compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15747deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15748
15749The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15750matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15751method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15752indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15753
15754As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15755when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15756mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15757the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15758ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15759
15760Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15761multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15762when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015763incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15764are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15766all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15767
15768Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15769 - name
15770 - name(arg1)
15771 - name(arg1,arg2)
15772
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015773
157747.3.1. Converters
15775-----------------
15776
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015777Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15778of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15779is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15780was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015781has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015782unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15783
15784These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15785sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15786the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015787support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015788
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015789A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15790support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15791supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15792(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15793bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015796
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001579751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15798 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15799 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15800 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15801 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15802 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15803
15804 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015805 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15806 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015807 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15808 frontend http-in
15809 bind *:8081
15810 default_backend servers
15811 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15812 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15813
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015814add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015815 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015816 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015817 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15818 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015819 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015820 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15821 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015825 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015826
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015827aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15828 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15829 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15830 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15831 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15832 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15833 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15834
15835 Example:
15836 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15837 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15838
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015839and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015840 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015841 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015842 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15843 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015844 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015845 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15846 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15847 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15848 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015849 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015850 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015851
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015852b64dec
15853 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15854 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015855 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15856 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015857
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015858base64
15859 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015860 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015861 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15862 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015863
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015864bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015865 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015866 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015867 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015868 presence of a flag).
15869
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015870bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15871 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15872 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015873 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015874
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015875concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15876 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15877 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15878 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15879 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15880 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15881 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15882 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15883 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15884 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15885 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015886 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015887 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015888 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15889 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015890
15891 Example:
15892 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15893 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15894 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015895 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015896 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15897
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015898cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015899 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15900 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015901
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015902crc32([<avalanche>])
15903 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15904 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15905 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15906 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15907 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15908 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15909 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15910 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15911 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15912 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015913 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15914
15915crc32c([<avalanche>])
15916 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15917 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15918 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15919 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15920 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15921 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15922 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15923 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015924
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015925cut_crlf
15926 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15927 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15928 updated.
15929
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015930da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015931 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15932 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15933 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15934 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015935 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015936 configuration language.
15937
15938 Example:
15939 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015940 bind *:8881
15941 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015942 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015943
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015944debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15945 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15946 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15947 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15948 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15949 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15950 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15951 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15952 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15953 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15954 printable sample types.
15955
15956 Example:
15957 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015958
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015959digest(<algorithm>)
15960 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15961 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15962
15963 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15964 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15965
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015966div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015967 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15968 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015969 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015970 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15971 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015972 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015973 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15974 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15975 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15976 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015977 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015978 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015979
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015980djb2([<avalanche>])
15981 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15982 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15983 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15984 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15985 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15986 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15987 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015988 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15989 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015990
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015991even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015992 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015993 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15994
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015995field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15996 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15997 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15998 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15999 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16000 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16001 fields.
16002
16003 Example :
16004 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16005 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16006 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16007 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16008 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016009
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016010fix_is_valid
16011 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16012 Information eXchange):
16013
16014 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16015 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016016 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016017 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016018 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016019 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16020 checksum
16021
16022 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16023 the server can be parsed.
16024
16025 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16026 message, false if not.
16027
16028 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16029
16030 Example:
16031 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16032 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16033
16034fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16035 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16036 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16037 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16038 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016039 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016040 added.
16041
16042 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16043 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16044 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16045 fix_is_valid converter.
16046
16047 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16048
16049 Example:
16050 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16051 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16052 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16053 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16054 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016056hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016057 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016058 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016059 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016060 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016061
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016062hex2i
16063 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016064 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016065
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016066htonl
16067 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16068 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16069 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16070 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16071
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016072hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016073 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16074 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16075 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16076 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16077
16078 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16079 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16080
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016081http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016082 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16083 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016084 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16085 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16086 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16087 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16088 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16089 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16090 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16091 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016093iif(<true>,<false>)
16094 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16095 string otherwise.
16096
16097 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016098 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016099
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016100in_table(<table>)
16101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16103 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016105 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16106
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016107ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016108 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016109 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016110 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16111 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16112 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16113 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16114 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016115
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016116json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016117 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016118 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016119 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016120 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16121 of errors:
16122 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16123 bytes, ...)
16124 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16125 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16126
16127 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16128 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16129 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16130 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16131 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16132 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016133 - "ascii" : never fails;
16134 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16135 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016136 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016137 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016138 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16139 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16140
16141 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016143
16144 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016145 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016146 capture request header user-agent len 150
16147 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016148
16149 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16150 GET / HTTP/1.0
16151 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16152
16153 Output log:
16154 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16155
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016156json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16157 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16158 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16159 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16160 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16161
16162 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16163 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16164
16165 Example:
16166 # get a integer value from the request body
16167 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16168 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16169
16170 # get a key with '.' in the name
16171 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16172 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16173
16174 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16175 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16176
16177 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16178 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016180language(<value>[,<default>])
16181 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16182 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16183 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16184 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16185 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16186 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16187 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16188 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16189 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016190 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016191 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16192 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016194 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016196 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16197 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016199 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16200 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16201 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16202 use_backend spanish if es
16203 use_backend french if fr
16204 use_backend english if en
16205 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016206
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016207length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016208 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16209 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16210 type. The result is of type integer.
16211
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016212lower
16213 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16214 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16215 type. The result is of type string.
16216
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016217ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16218 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16219 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16220 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16221 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16222 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16223 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16224
16225 Example :
16226
16227 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016228 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016229 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16230
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016231ltrim(<chars>)
16232 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16233 representation of the input sample.
16234
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016235map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16236map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16237map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16238 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16239 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16240 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16241 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16242 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16243 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16244 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16245 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016247 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16248 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16249 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016250
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016251 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016252 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016254 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16255 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16256 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16257 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016258 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16259 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016260 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16261 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16262 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16263 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16264 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16265 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16266 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16267 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016268 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16269 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16270 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016271 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16272 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16273 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16274 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16275 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016276
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016277 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16278 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16279 the corresponding match text.
16280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016281 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16282 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16283 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16284 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16285 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016286
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016287 Example :
16288
16289 # this is a comment and is ignored
16290 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16291 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16292 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16293 | | | `---------- value
16294 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16295 | `---------------------------- key
16296 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16297
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016298mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016299 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16300 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016301 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016302 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16307 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016308 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016309 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016310
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016311mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016312 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16313 <packettype>.
16314 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16315 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16316 from.
16317 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16318 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16319 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16320
16321 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16322 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16323 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16324 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16325
16326 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16327 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16328 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16329 packets only):
16330 17: Session Expiry Interval
16331 33: Receive Maximum
16332 39: Maximum Packet Size
16333 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16334 25: Request Response Information
16335 23: Request Problem Information
16336 21: Authentication Method
16337 22: Authentication Data
16338 18: Will Delay Interval
16339 1: Payload Format Indicator
16340 2: Message Expiry Interval
16341 3: Content Type
16342 8: Response Topic
16343 9: Correlation Data
16344 Not supported yet:
16345 38: User Property
16346
16347 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16348 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16349 packets only):
16350 17: Session Expiry Interval
16351 33: Receive Maximum
16352 36: Maximum QoS
16353 37: Retain Available
16354 39: Maximum Packet Size
16355 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16356 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16357 31: Reason String
16358 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16359 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16360 42: Shared Subscription Available
16361 19: Server Keep Alive
16362 26: Response Information
16363 28: Server Reference
16364 21: Authentication Method
16365 22: Authentication Data
16366 Not supported yet:
16367 38: User Property
16368
16369 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16370 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16371 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16372 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16373
16374 Example:
16375
16376 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16377 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16378 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16379 if data_in_buffer
16380 # do the same as above
16381 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16382 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16383 if data_in_buffer
16384
16385mqtt_is_valid
16386 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16387
16388 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16389 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16390 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16391 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16392
16393 Example:
16394
16395 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16396 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16397
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016398mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016399 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016400 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16401 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016402 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016403 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016404 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016405 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16406 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16408 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016410 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016411
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016412nbsrv
16413 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16414 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16415 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16416 map lookup.
16417
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016418neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016419 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16420 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16421 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16422 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016423
16424not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016425 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016426 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016427 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016428 absence of a flag).
16429
16430odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016431 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016432 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16433
16434or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016435 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016436 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016437 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16438 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016439 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016440 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16441 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16442 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16443 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016444 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016445 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016446
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016447protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16448 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16449 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16450 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16451 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16452 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16453 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16454 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16455 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16456 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16457 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16458 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16459
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016460regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016461 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16462 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16463 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16464 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16465 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16466 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16467 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16468 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16469 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016470 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16471 of characters with other ones.
16472
16473 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16474 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16475 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16476 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16477 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16478 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016479
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016480 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016481
16482 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16483 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16484 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016485 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016486
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016487 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16488 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16489
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016490 # capture groups and backreferences
16491 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016492 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016493 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16494
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016495capture-req(<id>)
16496 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16497 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16498
16499 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016500 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16501 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016502
16503capture-res(<id>)
16504 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16505 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16506
16507 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016508 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16509 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016510
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016511rtrim(<chars>)
16512 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16513 of the input sample.
16514
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016515sdbm([<avalanche>])
16516 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16517 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16518 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16519 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16520 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16521 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16522 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016523 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16524 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016525
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016526secure_memcmp(<var>)
16527 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16528 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16529 match.
16530
16531 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16532 performed in constant time.
16533
16534 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16535 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16536
16537 Example :
16538
16539 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16540 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16541 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16542 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16543
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016544set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016545 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16546 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16547 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016548 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016549 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16550 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016551 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016552 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16553 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016554 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016555 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016556
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016557sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016558 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016559 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16560
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016561sha2([<bits>])
16562 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16563 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16564
16565 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16566 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16567
16568 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16569 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16570
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016571srv_queue
16572 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16573 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16574 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16575 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16576 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16577
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016578strcmp(<var>)
16579 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16580 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16581 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16582 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16583 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16584 shorter).
16585
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016586 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16587 strings in constant time.
16588
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016589 Example :
16590
16591 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16592 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16593 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16594
16595
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016596sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016597 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16598 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016599 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016600 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16601 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016602 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016603 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16604 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016605 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16607 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016608 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016609 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016610
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016611table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16612 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16613 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16614 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16615 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16616 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16617 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16618
16619
16620table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16621 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16622 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16623 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16624 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16625 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16626 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16627
16628table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16629 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16630 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016631 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016632 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16633 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16634
16635table_conn_cur(<table>)
16636 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16637 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16638 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16639 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16640 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16641
16642table_conn_rate(<table>)
16643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16645 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16646 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16647 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16648
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016649table_gpt0(<table>)
16650 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16651 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16652 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16653 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16654 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16655
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016656table_gpc0(<table>)
16657 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16658 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16659 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16660 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16661 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16662
16663table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16664 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16665 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16666 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16667 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16668 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16669 sample fetch keyword.
16670
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016671table_gpc1(<table>)
16672 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16673 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16674 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16675 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16676 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16677
16678table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16679 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16680 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16681 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16682 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16683 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16684 sample fetch keyword.
16685
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016686table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016690 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16691 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16692
16693table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16694 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16695 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16696 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16697 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16698 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16699 keyword.
16700
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016701table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16704 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16705 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16706 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16707
16708table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16711 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16712 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16713 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16714 keyword.
16715
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016716table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16717 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16718 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016719 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016720 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16721 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16722
16723table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16724 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16725 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16726 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16727 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16728 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16729 keyword.
16730
16731table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16732 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16733 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016735 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16736 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16737 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16738 keyword.
16739
16740table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16741 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16742 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016743 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016744 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16745 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16746 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16747 keyword.
16748
16749table_server_id(<table>)
16750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16753 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16754 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16755 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16756
16757table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016761 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16762 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16763 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16764 keyword.
16765
16766table_sess_rate(<table>)
16767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16769 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16770 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16771 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16772 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16773 keyword.
16774
16775table_trackers(<table>)
16776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16779 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16780 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16781 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16782 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16783 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16784 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16785 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16786
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016787ub64dec
16788 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16789 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16790 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16791
16792 Example:
16793 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16794 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16795
16796ub64enc
16797 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16798
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016799upper
16800 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16801 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16802 type. The result is of type string.
16803
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016804url_dec([<in_form>])
16805 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16806 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16807 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16808 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16809 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16810 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016811
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016812url_enc([<enc_type>])
16813 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16814 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16815 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16816 optional argument is here for future changes.
16817
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016818ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016819 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016820 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16821 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16822 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016823 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16824 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16825 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16826 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016827 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016828 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16829 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016830
16831 Example:
16832 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16833 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16834
16835 message Point {
16836 int32 latitude = 1;
16837 int32 longitude = 2;
16838 }
16839
16840 message PPoint {
16841 Point point = 59;
16842 }
16843
16844 message Rectangle {
16845 // One corner of the rectangle.
16846 PPoint lo = 48;
16847 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16848 PPoint hi = 49;
16849 }
16850
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016851 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16852 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16853 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016854
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016855 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16856 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016857 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016858 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16859
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016860 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016861
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016862 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016863
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016864 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16865 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16866 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016867
16868 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16869 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16870 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16871
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016872 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16873 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16874 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016875
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016876
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016877unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016878 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16879 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16880 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16881 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16882 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16883 response),
16884 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16885 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16887 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16888
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016889utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16890 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16891 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16892 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16893 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16894 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16895 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16896
16897 Example :
16898
16899 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016900 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016901 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16902
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016903word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16904 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16905 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16906 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016907 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016908 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16909 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16910
16911 Example :
16912 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16913 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16914 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16915 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16916 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016917 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016918
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016919wt6([<avalanche>])
16920 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16921 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16922 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16923 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16924 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16925 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16926 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016927 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16928 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016929
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016930xor(<value>)
16931 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016932 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016933 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016934 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016935 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016936 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16937 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016938 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016939 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16940 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016942 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016943
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016944xxh3([<seed>])
16945 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16946 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16947 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16948 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16949 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16950 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16951 considered as cryptographically secure.
16952
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016953xxh32([<seed>])
16954 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16955 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16956 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16957 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16958 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16959 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16960 as cryptographically secure.
16961
16962xxh64([<seed>])
16963 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16964 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16965 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16966 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16967 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16968 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16969 as cryptographically secure.
16970
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169727.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016973--------------------------------------------
16974
16975A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16976not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16977"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16978The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16979
16980always_false : boolean
16981 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16982 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16983
16984always_true : boolean
16985 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16986 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16987
16988avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016989 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016990 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16991 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16992 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16993 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16994 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16995 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16996 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16997 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16998 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16999 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17000 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17001 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17002 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017005 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17006 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17007 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17008 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017009 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17010
17011be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17013 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17014 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17015 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17016 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017017 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17018 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017019
17020 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17021 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17022 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17026 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17027 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017028 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17030 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017031
17032 Example :
17033 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17034 backend dynamic
17035 mode http
17036 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17037 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017039bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017040 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17041 of the string.
17042
17043bool(<bool>) : bool
17044 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17045 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017047connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17048 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017049 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17051 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017052
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017053 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017054 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017055 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17056
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017057 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17058 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017059
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017060 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017061 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017062 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017063 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017064 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017066 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017067
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017068 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17069 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017070 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017071 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017072
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017073cpu_calls : integer
17074 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17075 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17076 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17077 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17078 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17079 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17080
17081cpu_ns_avg : integer
17082 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17083 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17084 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17085 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17086 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17087 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17088 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17089 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17090 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17091 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17092 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17093
17094cpu_ns_tot : integer
17095 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17096 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17097 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17098 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17099 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17100 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17101 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17102 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17103 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17104 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17105 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17106 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17107 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17108
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017109date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017110 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017111
17112 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17113 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17114 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017115 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17116
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017117 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17118 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17119 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17120 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17121 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17122
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017123 Example :
17124
17125 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17126 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017127
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017128 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17129 # millisecond granularity
17130 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17131
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017132date_us : integer
17133 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17134 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17135 from the same timeval structure.
17136
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017137distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17138 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17139 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17140 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17141 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17142 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17143 list of supported tokens.
17144
17145distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17146 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17147 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17148 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17149 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17150 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17151 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17152 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17153 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17154 supported tokens.
17155
17156 Example :
17157 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17158 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17159 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17160 # send large files to the big farm
17161 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17162
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017163env(<name>) : string
17164 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17165 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17166 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17167 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17168 certain way.
17169
17170 Examples :
17171 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17172 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17173
17174 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17175 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017177fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17178 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017179 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17180 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17182 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017183 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17185 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017186
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017187fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17188 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17189 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17190 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017192fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17193 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17194 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17195 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17196 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17197 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17198 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17199 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17200 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017201
17202 Example :
17203 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17204 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17205 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17206 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17207 frontend mail
17208 bind :25
17209 mode tcp
17210 maxconn 100
17211 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17212 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17213 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17214 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017215
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017216hostname : string
17217 Returns the system hostname.
17218
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017219int(<integer>) : signed integer
17220 Returns a signed integer.
17221
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017222ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17223 Returns an ipv4.
17224
17225ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17226 Returns an ipv6.
17227
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017228lat_ns_avg : integer
17229 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17230 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17231 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17232 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17233 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17234 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17235 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17236 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17237 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017238 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17239 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17240 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17241 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17242 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17243 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017244
17245lat_ns_tot : integer
17246 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17247 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17248 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17249 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17250 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17251 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17252 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17253 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17254 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017255 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17256 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17257 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17258 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17259 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017260 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17261 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17262 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17263 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17264 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17265 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17266
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017267meth(<method>) : method
17268 Returns a method.
17269
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017270nbproc : integer
17271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17272 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17273 and debugging purposes.
17274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17277 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17278 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017279 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17280 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17281 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017282
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017283prio_class : integer
17284 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17285 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17286 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17287
17288prio_offset : integer
17289 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17290 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17291 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17292 set-priority-offset".
17293
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017294proc : integer
17295 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17296 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17297 debugging purposes.
17298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017299queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017300 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17301 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17302 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017303 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17304 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17305 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17306 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17307 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17308
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017309rand([<range>]) : integer
17310 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17311 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17312 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17313 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17314 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17315
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017316uuid([<version>]) : string
17317 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17318 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17319 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17322 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17323 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17324 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17325 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17326 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017327 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17328 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17329
17330srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17331 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17332 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17333 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17334 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17335 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17336 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17337 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17338
17339 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17340 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341
17342srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17343 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17344 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17345 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017346 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17348 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17349 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17350
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017351srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17353 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17354 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17355 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17356 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17357 fetch methods.
17358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017359srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17360 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17361 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017362 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017363 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17364 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017365 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366 overloading servers).
17367
17368 Example :
17369 # Redirect to a separate back
17370 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17371 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17372 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17373
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017374srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017375 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17376 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17377 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17378
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017379srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017380 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17381 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17382 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17383
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017384srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017385 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17386 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17387 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17388
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017389stopping : boolean
17390 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17391 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17392 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17393
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017394str(<string>) : string
17395 Returns a string.
17396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17398 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17399 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17400
17401table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17402 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17403 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17404 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17405
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017406thread : integer
17407 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17408 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17409 and debugging purposes.
17410
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017411var(<var-name>) : undefined
17412 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017413 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17414 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017415 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017416 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17417 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017418 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017419 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17420 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017421 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017422 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174247.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425----------------------------------
17426
17427The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17428closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17429methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17430sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17431TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017432the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17433counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017434"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17435used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17436can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17437Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17438table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17439tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17440currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017442bc_dst : ip
17443 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17444 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17445 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17446 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17447
17448bc_dst_port : integer
17449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17450 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17451
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017452bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017453 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17454 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17455 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17456
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017457bc_src : ip
17458 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17459 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17460 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17461 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17462
17463bc_src_port : integer
17464 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17465 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017467be_id : integer
17468 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017469 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17470 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017471
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017472be_name : string
17473 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017474 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17475 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017476
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017477be_server_timeout : integer
17478 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17479 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17480 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17481
17482be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17483 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17484 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17485 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17486
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017487cur_server_timeout : integer
17488 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17489 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17490 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17491
17492cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17493 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17494 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17495 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497dst : ip
17498 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17499 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17500 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17501 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017502 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17503 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17504 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17505 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17506 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17507 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508
17509dst_conn : integer
17510 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17511 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17512 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17513 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17514 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17515 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17516 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17517 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017518
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017519dst_is_local : boolean
17520 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17521 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17522 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17523 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017524 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017525 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17526 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17527 it only once per connection.
17528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529dst_port : integer
17530 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17531 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17532 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17533 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17534 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17535 an HTTP header.
17536
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017537fc_http_major : integer
17538 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17539 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17540 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17541
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017542fc_pp_authority : string
17543 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17544 if any.
17545
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017546fc_pp_unique_id : string
17547 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17548 if any.
17549
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017550fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17551 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17552 header.
17553
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017554fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17555 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17556 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17557 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17558 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17559 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17560 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17561
17562fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17563 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17564 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17565 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17566 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17567 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17568 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17569
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017570fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017571 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17572 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17573 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17574 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17575
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017576fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017577 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17578 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17579 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17580 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17581
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017582fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017583 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17584 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17585 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17586 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17587
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017588fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017589 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17590 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17591 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17592 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17593
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017594fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017595 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17596 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17597 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17598 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17599
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017600fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017601 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17602 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17603 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17604 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17605
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017606fe_defbe : string
17607 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17608 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017610fe_id : integer
17611 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017612 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17614
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017615fe_name : string
17616 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17617 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17618 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17619
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017620fe_client_timeout : integer
17621 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17622 current frontend.
17623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017624sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017625sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17626sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17627sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017628 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17629 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17630 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017632sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017633sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17634sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17635sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017636 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17637 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17638 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017640sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017641sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17642sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17643sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017644 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17645 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017646 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17647 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17648 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017649
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017650 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017651 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17652 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017653 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17654 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17655 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017656 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17658
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017659sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17660sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17661sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17662sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17663 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17664 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17665 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17666 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17667 when a first ACL was verified.
17668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017669sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017670sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17671sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17672sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017673 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017674 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17675
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017676sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017677sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17678sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17679sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017680 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17681 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17682 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017684sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017685sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17686sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17687sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017688 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17689 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17690 See also src_conn_rate.
17691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017692sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017693sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17694sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17695sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017696 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017697 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017698
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017699sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17700sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17701sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17702sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17703 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17704 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17705
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017706sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17707sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17708sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17709sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17710 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17711 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17712
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017713sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017714sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17715sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17716sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017717 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17718 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17719 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017720 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17721 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17722 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017723
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017724sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17725sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17726sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17727sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17728 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17729 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17730 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17731 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17732 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17733 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017735sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017736sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17737sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17738sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017739 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017740 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17741 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017743sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017744sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17745sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17746sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017747 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17748 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17749 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17750 src_http_err_rate.
17751
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017752sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17753sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17754sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17755sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17756 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17757 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17758 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17759
17760sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17761sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17762sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17763sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17764 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17765 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17766 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17767 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017769sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017770sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17771sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17772sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017773 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017774 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17775 src_http_req_cnt.
17776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017777sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017778sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17779sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17780sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017781 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17782 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17783 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17784 src_http_req_rate.
17785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017786sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017787sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17788sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17789sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017790 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017791 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17792 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17793 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17794 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017795
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017796 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017797 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17798 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017799 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17800
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017801sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17802sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17803sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17804sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17805 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17806 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17807 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17808 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17809 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017811sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017812sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17813sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17814sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017815 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17816 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17817 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017819sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017820sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17821sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17822sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017823 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17824 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17825 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017827sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017828sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17829sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17830sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017831 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017832 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17833 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17834 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017835 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017836 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17837
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017838sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017839sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17840sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17841sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017842 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17843 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17844 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17845 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17846 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017847 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017849sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017850sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17851sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17852sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017853 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17854 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17855 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017857sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017858sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17859sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17860sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017861 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17862 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017863 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017864 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17865 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017866 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17867 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17868 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870so_id : integer
17871 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17872 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17873 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017874
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017875so_name : string
17876 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17877 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17878 strings instead of integers.
17879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017881 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017882 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17883 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17884 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017885 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17886 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17887 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017888 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17889 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17890 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17891 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17892 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17893 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17894 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017895
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017896 Example:
17897 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17898 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17901 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17902 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17903 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017904 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017906src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17907 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17908 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017909 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017910 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17913 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17914 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17915 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17916 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17917 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17918 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017919
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017920 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017921 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17922 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17923 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17924 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017925 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017926 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17927 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17928
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017929src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17930 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17931 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17932 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17933 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17934 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17935 was verified.
17936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017938 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017940 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017941 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017944 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17946 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017947 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17950 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17951 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17952 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017953 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017955src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017956 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017957 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017958 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017959 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017960
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017961src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17962 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17963 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17964 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17965 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17966
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017967src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17969 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17970 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17971 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017974 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017976 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17977 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017978 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17979 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17980 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017981
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017982src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17984 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17985 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17986 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17987 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17988 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17989 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017991src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017992 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017993 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017994 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017995 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017996 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17999 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18000 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18001 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18002 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018003 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018004
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018005src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18006 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18007 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018008 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018009 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18010 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18011
18012src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18013 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18014 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18015 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18016 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18017 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18018 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18023 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018024 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018026src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18027 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18028 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18029 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018030 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018031 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18034 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18035 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18036 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018037 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018038 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18039 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018040
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018041 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018042 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018043 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018044 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018045
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018046src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18047 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18048 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18049 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18050 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18051 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18052 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18053
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018054src_is_local : boolean
18055 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18056 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18057 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18058 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018059 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018060 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18061 once per connection.
18062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018064 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18065 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18066 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18067 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18068 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018071 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18072 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18073 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18074 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18075 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077src_port : integer
18078 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18079 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18080 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18081 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018084 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018085 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18086 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18087 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018088 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18091 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18092 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18093 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18094 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018095 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18098 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18099 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18100 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18101 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18102 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18103 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18104 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18105 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018106
18107 Example :
18108 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18109 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18110 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18111 listen ssh
18112 bind :22
18113 mode tcp
18114 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018115 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018117 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119srv_id : integer
18120 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18121 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018122 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018123
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018124srv_name : string
18125 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18126 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018127 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018128
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181297.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018130----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18133closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18134when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18135usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018136future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018137
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001813851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18139 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18140 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18141 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18142 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18143 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18144
18145 Example :
18146 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18147 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18148 # the request.
18149 frontend http-in
18150 bind *:8081
18151 default_backend servers
18152 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18153 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18154
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018155ssl_bc : boolean
18156 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18157 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018158 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18159 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018160
18161ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18162 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018163 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18164 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018165
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018166ssl_bc_alpn : string
18167 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18168 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018169 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018170 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18171 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18172 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18173 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18174 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018175 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18176 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018177
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018178ssl_bc_cipher : string
18179 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018180 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18181 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018182
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018183ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18184 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18185 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18186 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018187 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018188
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018189ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18190 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18191 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018192 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18193 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018194
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018195ssl_bc_npn : string
18196 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18197 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018198 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018199 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18200 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18201 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18202 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018203 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18204 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018205
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018206ssl_bc_protocol : string
18207 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018208 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18209 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018210
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018211ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018212 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018213 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018214 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18215 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018216
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018217ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18218 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18219 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18220 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018221 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018222
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018223ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18224 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18225 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018226 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18227 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018228
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018229ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18230 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18231 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18232 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018233 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018234
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018235ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18236 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018237 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18238 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18241 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18242 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18243 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18244 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18245 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18248 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18249 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18250 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18251 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018252
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018253ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018254 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18255 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18256 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018257 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018258 does not support resumed sessions.
18259
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018260ssl_c_der : binary
18261 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18262 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18263 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265ssl_c_err : integer
18266 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18267 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18268 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18269 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18270 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018271
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018272ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18274 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18275 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18276 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18277 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18278 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18279 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18280 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018281 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18282 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18283 LDAP v3.
18284 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18285 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287ssl_c_key_alg : string
18288 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18289 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18290 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292ssl_c_notafter : string
18293 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18294 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18295 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018297ssl_c_notbefore : string
18298 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18299 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18300 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018301
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018302ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18304 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18305 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18306 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18307 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18308 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18309 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18310 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018311 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18312 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18313 LDAP v3.
18314 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18315 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317ssl_c_serial : binary
18318 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18319 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18320 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018322ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18323 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18324 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18325 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018326 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18327 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18328
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018329 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018330 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18333 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18334 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18335 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337ssl_c_used : boolean
18338 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18339 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341ssl_c_verify : integer
18342 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18343 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18344 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18345 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347ssl_c_version : integer
18348 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18349 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018350
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018351ssl_f_der : binary
18352 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18353 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18354 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18355
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018356ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18358 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18359 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18360 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018361 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18363 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18364 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018365 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18366 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18367 LDAP v3.
18368 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18369 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371ssl_f_key_alg : string
18372 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18373 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18374 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376ssl_f_notafter : string
18377 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18378 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18379 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381ssl_f_notbefore : string
18382 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18383 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18384 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018385
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018386ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18388 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18389 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18390 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18391 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18392 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18393 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18394 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018395 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18396 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18397 LDAP v3.
18398 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18399 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401ssl_f_serial : binary
18402 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18403 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18404 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018405
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018406ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18407 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18408 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18409 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18412 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18413 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18414 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416ssl_f_version : integer
18417 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18418 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18419
18420ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018421 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18422 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18423 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425 Example :
18426 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18427 listen http-https
18428 bind :80
18429 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18430 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18431
18432ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18433 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18434 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18435
18436ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018437 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18439 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18440 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18441 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18442 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18443 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18444 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18445 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447ssl_fc_cipher : string
18448 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18449 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018450
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018451ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18452 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18453 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018454 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018455
18456ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18457 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18458 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018459 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018460
18461ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18462 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18463 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18464 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018465 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018466 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018467
18468ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18469 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18470 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018471 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018472
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018473ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18474 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18475 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18476 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18477
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018478ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18479 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18480 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18481 transport layer.
18482 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18483 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18484 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18485 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18486
18487ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18488 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18489 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18490 transport layer.
18491 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18492 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18493 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18494 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18495
18496ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18497 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18498 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18499 transport layer.
18500 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18501 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18502 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18503 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18504
18505ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18506 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18507 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18508 transport layer.
18509 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18510 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18511 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18512 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18513
18514ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18515 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18516 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18517 transport layer.
18518 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18519 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18520 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18521 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018524 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18525 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018526 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18527 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18528 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18529 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018530
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018531ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18532 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18533 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18534 wait until the handshake happened.
18535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18537 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018538 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18539 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018540 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018541 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018542
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018543ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018544 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018545 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18546 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018548ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018549 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018550 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18551 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18552 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18553 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18554 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18555 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18556 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018558ssl_fc_protocol : string
18559 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18560 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018561
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018562ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018563 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018564 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18565 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018566
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018567ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18568 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18569 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18570 transport layer.
18571 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18572 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18573 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18574 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18575
18576ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18577 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18578 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18579 transport layer.
18580 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18581 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18582 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18583 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18584
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018585ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18586 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18587 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18588 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18591 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18592 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18593 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18594 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018595
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018596ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18597 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18598 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18599 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18600 BoringSSL.
18601
18602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603ssl_fc_sni : string
18604 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18605 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18606 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18607 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18608 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18609
18610 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18611 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18612 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018613 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018614 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018616 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18618 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018620ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18621 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18622 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018623
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018624ssl_s_der : binary
18625 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18626 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18627 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18628
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018629ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18630 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18631 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18632 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018633 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018634 does not support resumed sessions.
18635
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018636ssl_s_key_alg : string
18637 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18638 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18639 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18640
18641ssl_s_notafter : string
18642 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18643 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18644 transport layer.
18645
18646ssl_s_notbefore : string
18647 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18648 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18649 transport layer.
18650
18651ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18652 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18653 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18654 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18655 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18656 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18657 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018658 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18659 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018660 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18661 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18662 LDAP v3.
18663 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18664 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18665
18666ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18667 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18668 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18669 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18670 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18671 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18672 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018673 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18674 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018675 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18676 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18677 LDAP v3.
18678 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18679 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18680
18681ssl_s_serial : binary
18682 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18683 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18684 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18685
18686ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18687 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18688 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18689 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18690
18691ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18692 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18693 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18694 layer.
18695
18696ssl_s_version : integer
18697 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18698 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018699
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187007.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018701------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18704sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18705only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18706For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18707be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18708can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18709sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18710for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18711content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018712
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018713Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18714 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18715 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18716 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18717 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18718 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18719 sample expression). So be careful.
18720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018721payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018722 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18724 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018726payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18727 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018728 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018731req.len : integer
18732req_len : integer (deprecated)
18733 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18734 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18735 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18736 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18737 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18738 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18739 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18740 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18743 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018744 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18745 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18746 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18747 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018749 ACL alternatives :
18750 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18753 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18754 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18755 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18756 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018758 ACL alternatives :
18759 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018763req.proto_http : boolean
18764req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18765 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18766 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18767 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18768 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18769 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18770 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18771 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018773 Example:
18774 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18775 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18776 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018777 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18780rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18781 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18782 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18783 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18784 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18785 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18786 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18787 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18790 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18791 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18792 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18793 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18794 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018796 ACL derivatives :
18797 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 Example :
18800 listen tse-farm
18801 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18802 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18803 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18804 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18805 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18806 persist rdp-cookie
18807 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18808 # This is only useful makes sense if
18809 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18810 stick-table type string size 204800
18811 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18812 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18813 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18816 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18819rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18820 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18821 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18822 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18823 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 ACL derivatives :
18826 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018827
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018828req.ssl_alpn : string
18829 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18830 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18831 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18832 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18833 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18834 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018835 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018836
18837 Examples :
18838 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18839 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18840 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018841 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018842 default_backend bk_default
18843
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018844req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18845 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18846 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018847 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18848 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18849 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18850 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18851 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18854req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18855 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18856 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18857 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18858 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18859 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18860 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18861 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863req.ssl_sni : string
18864req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18865 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18866 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18867 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18868 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18869 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018870 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18871 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18872 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18873 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18874 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18875 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18876 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18877 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18878 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018880 ACL derivatives :
18881 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018883 Examples :
18884 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18885 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18886 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18887 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18888 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018889
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018890req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18891 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18892 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18893 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18894 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18895 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18896 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18897 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18898 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18899 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901req.ssl_ver : integer
18902req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18903 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18904 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18905 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18906 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18907 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18908 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18909 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018910 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913 ACL derivatives :
18914 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018915
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018916res.len : integer
18917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18918 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18919 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18920 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18921 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18922 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18923 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018924 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18927 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018928 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018929 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018930 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018931 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18934 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18935 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18936 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018937 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18938 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018940 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018941
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018942res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18943rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18944 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18945 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18946 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18947 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18948 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18949 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18950 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018952wait_end : boolean
18953 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18954 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018955 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18957 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018958 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18960 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018962 Examples :
18963 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18964 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18965 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18968 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18969 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18970 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18971 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18972 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18973 tcp-request content reject
18974
18975
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189767.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977--------------------------------------
18978
18979It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18980This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18981data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18982its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18983HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18984content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18985to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18986more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18987response are indexed.
18988
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018989Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18990 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18991 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18992 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18993 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18994 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18995 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997base : string
18998 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18999 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19000 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19001 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19002 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19003 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19004 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19005 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19006
19007 ACL derivatives :
19008 base : exact string match
19009 base_beg : prefix match
19010 base_dir : subdir match
19011 base_dom : domain match
19012 base_end : suffix match
19013 base_len : length match
19014 base_reg : regex match
19015 base_sub : substring match
19016
19017base32 : integer
19018 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19019 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19020 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019021 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19022 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19023 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019024
19025base32+src : binary
19026 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19027 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19028 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19029 per-URL counters.
19030
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019031baseq : string
19032 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19033 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19034 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19035 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19036
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019037capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19038 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19039 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19040 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19041
19042capture.req.method : string
19043 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19044 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19045 because it's allocated.
19046
19047capture.req.uri : string
19048 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19049 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19050 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19051 allocated.
19052
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019053capture.req.ver : string
19054 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19055 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19056 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19057
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019058capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19059 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19060 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19061 The first entry is an index of 0.
19062 See also: "capture response header"
19063
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019064capture.res.ver : string
19065 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19066 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19067 persistent flag.
19068
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019069req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019070 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19071 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19072 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019073
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019074req.body_param([<name>) : string
19075 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19076 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19077 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19078 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19079 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19080 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19081 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19082 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19083 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19084 given.
19085
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019086req.body_len : integer
19087 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19088 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019089 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19090 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019091
19092req.body_size : integer
19093 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019094 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19095 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097req.cook([<name>]) : string
19098cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19099 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19100 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19101 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19102 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19103 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19104 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19105 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19106 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19107
19108 ACL derivatives :
19109 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19110 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19111 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19112 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19113 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19114 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19115 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19116 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19119cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19120 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19121 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019123req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19124cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19125 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19126 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19127 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19128 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019130cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19131 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19132 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19133 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19134 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019135 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19137 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19138 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19139 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19142 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19143 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19144 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19145 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019146 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019149 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19150 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19151 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19152 with headers such as User-Agent.
19153
19154 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19155 found.
19156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19158 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19159 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019160 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19163 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19164 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019165 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19166 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019169 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19170 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19171 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19172 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19173 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19174 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19175 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19176
19177 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19178 found.
19179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19181 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19182 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019183 with -1 being the last one.
19184
19185 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19186 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019188 ACL derivatives :
19189 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19190 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19191 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19192 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19193 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19194 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19195 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19196 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19197
19198req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19199hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19200 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19201 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019202 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19203 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19204 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19205
19206 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19207 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19208 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19209
19210 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211
19212req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19213hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19214 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19215 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19216 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019217 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19218 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19219 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19220 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19221 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019222
19223 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19224
19225 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019226
19227req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19228hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19229 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19230 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19231 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019232
19233 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19234
19235 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019236
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019237req.hdrs : string
19238 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19239 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19240 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19241 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19242
19243req.hdrs_bin : binary
19244 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19245 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19246 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19247 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19248 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19249 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19250
19251 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019252
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019253 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19254 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19257 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19258 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19259 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19260 basic auth is supported.
19261
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019262http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19263 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19264 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19265 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19266 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019267 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19268 basic auth is supported.
19269
19270 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019271 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19272 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19273 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19274 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019275
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019276http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019277 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19278 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19279 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019280
19281http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019282 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19283 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19284 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019285
19286http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019287 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19288 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19289 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019292 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19293 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019294 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19295 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297method : integer + string
19298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19299 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19300 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19301 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19302 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19303 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19304 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306 ACL derivatives :
19307 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019309 Example :
19310 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19311 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19312 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314path : string
19315 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19316 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19317 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19318 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19319 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019320 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019321 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019323 ACL derivatives :
19324 path : exact string match
19325 path_beg : prefix match
19326 path_dir : subdir match
19327 path_dom : domain match
19328 path_end : suffix match
19329 path_len : length match
19330 path_reg : regex match
19331 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019332
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019333pathq : string
19334 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19335 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19336 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19337 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19338 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19339 result in both cases.
19340
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019341query : string
19342 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19343 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19344 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19345 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019346 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019347 which stops before the question mark.
19348
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019349req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19350 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19351 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19352 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19353 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355req.ver : string
19356req_ver : string (deprecated)
19357 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19358 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19359 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361 ACL derivatives :
19362 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019363
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019364res.body : binary
19365 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19366 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019367 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19368
19369 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019370
19371res.body_len : integer
19372 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19373 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019374 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19375
19376 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019377
19378res.body_size : integer
19379 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19380 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19381 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19382 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019383 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19384
19385 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019386
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019387res.cache_hit : boolean
19388 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19389 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19390
19391res.cache_name : string
19392 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19393 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19394 empty string.
19395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396res.comp : boolean
19397 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19398 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19399 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401res.comp_algo : string
19402 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19403 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19404 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406res.cook([<name>]) : string
19407scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19408 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19409 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019410 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19411
19412 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414 ACL derivatives :
19415 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19418scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19419 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19420 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019421 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19422
19423 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019425res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19426scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19427 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19428 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019429 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19430
19431 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019433res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019434 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19435 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19436
19437 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19438 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19439
19440 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19441
19442 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019444res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019445 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19446 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19447
19448 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19449 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19450
19451 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19454shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019455 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19456 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19457
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019458 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019459 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19460
19461 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463 ACL derivatives :
19464 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19465 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19466 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19467 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19468 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19469 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19470 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19471 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19472
19473res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19474shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019475 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19476 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19477
19478 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019479 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019480
19481 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019483res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19484shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019485 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19486 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19487
19488 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19489
19490 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019491
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019492res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19493 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19494 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19495 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019496 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19497
19498 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19501shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019502 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19503 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19504
19505 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19506
19507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019508
19509res.hdrs : string
19510 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19511 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19512 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019513 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19514
19515 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019516
19517res.hdrs_bin : binary
19518 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19519 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19520 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19521 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19522 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19523 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19524 (length of 0 for both).
19525
19526 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19527
19528 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19529 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531res.ver : string
19532resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19533 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019534 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19535
19536 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538 ACL derivatives :
19539 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019541set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19542 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19543 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019544 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19548 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550status : integer
19551 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19552 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019553 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19554
19555 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019556
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019557unique-id : string
19558 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19559 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19560 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19561 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19562 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19563 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019565url : string
19566 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19567 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19568 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19569 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19570 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19571 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19572 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574 ACL derivatives :
19575 url : exact string match
19576 url_beg : prefix match
19577 url_dir : subdir match
19578 url_dom : domain match
19579 url_end : suffix match
19580 url_len : length match
19581 url_reg : regex match
19582 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584url_ip : ip
19585 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19586 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19587 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19588 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19589 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19590 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19591 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593url_port : integer
19594 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19595 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19596 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19597 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019598
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019599urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19600url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019601 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19602 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019603 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19604 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19605 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19606 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19608 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019609 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19610 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019612 ACL derivatives :
19613 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19614 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19615 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19616 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19617 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19618 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19619 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19620 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019621
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623 Example :
19624 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19625 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19626 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19627 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019628
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019629urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19631 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19632 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019633
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019634url32 : integer
19635 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19636 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19637 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19638 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19639 is an unsigned integer.
19640
19641url32+src : binary
19642 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19643 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19644 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19645
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019646
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200196477.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019648---------------------------------------
19649
19650This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19651used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19652purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19653There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19654or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19655any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19656for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19657
19658internal.htx.data : integer
19659 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19660 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19661
19662internal.htx.free : integer
19663 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19664 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19665
19666internal.htx.free_data : integer
19667 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19668 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19669
19670internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019671 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19672 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19673 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019674
19675internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19676 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19677 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19678
19679internal.htx.size : integer
19680 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19681 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19682
19683internal.htx.used : integer
19684 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19685 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19686 direction.
19687
19688internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19689 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19690 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19691 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19692 of the special value :
19693 * head : The oldest inserted block
19694 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019695 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019696
19697internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19698 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19699 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19700 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19701 integer or one of the special value :
19702 * head : The oldest inserted block
19703 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019704 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019705
19706internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19707 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19708 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19709 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19710 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19711
19712 * head : The oldest inserted block
19713 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019714 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019715
19716internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19717 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19718 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19719 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19720 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19721
19722 * head : The oldest inserted block
19723 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019724 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019725
19726internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19727 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19728 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19729 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19730 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19731
19732 * head : The oldest inserted block
19733 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019734 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019735
19736internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19737 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19738 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19739 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19740 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19741
19742 * head : The oldest inserted block
19743 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019744 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019745
19746internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19747 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19748 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19749 it returns false.
19750
19751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200197527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019753---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019755Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19756every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019757order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019759ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019760---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19761FALSE always_false never match
19762HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19763HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19764HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019765HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019766HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19767HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19768HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19769HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19770LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19771METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19772METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19773METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19774METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19775METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19776METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19777METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19778METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19779RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19780REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19781TRUE always_true always match
19782WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19783---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019784
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197868. Logging
19787----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019789One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19790provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19791very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19792provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19793state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019794to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019795headers.
19796
19797In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19798about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19799send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19800
19801 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19802 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19803 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19804 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19805 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019806 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019807 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019808
19809The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19810allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19811as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19812while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19813real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19814delay.
19815
19816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198178.1. Log levels
19818---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019819
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019820TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019821source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019822HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19823in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19824track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19825syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19826about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019827
19828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198298.2. Log formats
19830----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019831
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019832HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019833and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19834slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19835options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019836
19837 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19838 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19839 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19840 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19841 extents.
19842
19843 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19844 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19845 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19846 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19847 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19848
19849 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19850 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19851 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19852 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19853 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19854
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019855 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19856 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19857 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19858 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19859
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019860 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19861
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019862Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19863specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19864field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19865servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19866always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19867identifier.
19868
19869Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19870 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19871 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19872 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19873 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19874
19875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198768.2.1. Default log format
19877-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019878
19879This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19880as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19881format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19882
19883 Example :
19884 listen www
19885 mode http
19886 log global
19887 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19888
19889 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19890 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19891 (www/HTTP)
19892
19893 Field Format Extract from the example above
19894 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19895 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19896 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19897 4 'to' to
19898 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19899 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19900
19901Detailed fields description :
19902 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19903 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19904 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19905 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19906 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19907 and processed the connection.
19908 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19909
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019910In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19911"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19912connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19913
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019914It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19915will eventually disappear.
19916
19917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199188.2.2. TCP log format
19919---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019920
19921The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19922is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19923information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19924counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19925emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19926environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19927the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19928sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019929specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19930not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19931fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19932marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019933
19934 Example :
19935 frontend fnt
19936 mode tcp
19937 option tcplog
19938 log global
19939 default_backend bck
19940
19941 backend bck
19942 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19943
19944 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19945 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19946 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19947
19948 Field Format Extract from the example above
19949 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19950 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19951 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19952 4 frontend_name fnt
19953 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19954 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19955 7 bytes_read* 212
19956 8 termination_state --
19957 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19958 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19959
19960Detailed fields description :
19961 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019962 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19963 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19964 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019965 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019966 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019967 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019968
19969 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019970 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19971 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19972 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019973
19974 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19975 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19976 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019977 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19978 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19979 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19980 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019981
19982 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19983 and processed the connection.
19984
19985 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19986 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19987 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19988 applications.
19989
19990 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19991 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19992 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19993 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19994 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19995
19996 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19997 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19998 See "Timers" below for more details.
19999
20000 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20001 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20002 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20003 "Timers" below for more details.
20004
20005 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020006 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020007 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20008 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20009 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20010 details.
20011
20012 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20013 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20014 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20015 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20016 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20017
20018 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20019 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20020 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20021 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20022 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20023 for more details.
20024
20025 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020026 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020027 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20028 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20029 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020030 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020031
20032 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20033 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20034 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20035 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20036 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20037 caused by a denial of service attack.
20038
20039 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20040 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20041 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20042 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20043 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20044 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20045 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20046 denial of service attack.
20047
20048 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20049 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20050 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20051 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20052 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20053 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20054 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20055 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20056 be processed than on other servers.
20057
20058 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20059 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20060 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20061 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20062 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20063 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20064 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20065 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20066 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20067 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20068 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20069 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20070 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20071
20072 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20073 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20074 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20075 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20076 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20077 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020078 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20080
20081 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20082 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20083 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20084 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20085 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20086 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020087 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020088 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20089 occurs.
20090
20091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200928.2.3. HTTP log format
20093----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020094
20095The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20096is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20097the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20098are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20099emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20100generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20101"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20102which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020103frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20104is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020105
20106Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20107slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20108with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20109
20110 Example :
20111 frontend http-in
20112 mode http
20113 option httplog
20114 log global
20115 default_backend bck
20116
20117 backend static
20118 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20119
20120 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20121 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20122 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020123 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020124
20125 Field Format Extract from the example above
20126 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20127 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020128 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020129 4 frontend_name http-in
20130 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020131 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020132 7 status_code 200
20133 8 bytes_read* 2750
20134 9 captured_request_cookie -
20135 10 captured_response_cookie -
20136 11 termination_state ----
20137 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20138 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20139 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20140 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20141 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020143Detailed fields description :
20144 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020145 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20146 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20147 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020148 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020149 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020150 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020151
20152 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020153 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20154 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20155 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020156
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020157 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20158 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020159
20160 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20161 and processed the connection.
20162
20163 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20164 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20165 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20166
20167 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20168 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20169 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20170 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20171 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20172 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020174 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20175 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20176 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020177 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020178 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20179 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020180 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20181 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020182
20183 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20184 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020185 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020186
20187 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20188 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020189 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20190 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20193 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20194 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20195 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20196 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020197 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20198 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020199
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020200 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20201 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20202 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20203 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20204 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20205 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20206 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020207 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020208
20209 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20210 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20211 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20212
20213 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20214 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020215 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20217 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20218 overflowing.
20219
20220 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20221 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20222 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20223 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20224 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20225 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20226 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20227 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20228
20229 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20230 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20231 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20232 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20233 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20234 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20235 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20236 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20237
20238 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20239 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20240 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20241 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20242 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20243 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20244 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20245
20246 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020247 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020248 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20249 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20250 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020251 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020252 system.
20253
20254 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20255 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20256 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20257 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20258 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20259 caused by a denial of service attack.
20260
20261 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20262 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20263 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20264 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20265 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20266 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20267 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20268 denial of service attack.
20269
20270 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20271 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20272 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20273 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20274 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20275 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20276 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20277 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20278 processed than on other servers.
20279
20280 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20281 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20282 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20283 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20284 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20285 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20286 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20287 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20288 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20289 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20290 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20291 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20292 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20293
20294 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20295 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20296 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20297 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20298 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20299 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020300 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020301 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20302
20303 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20304 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20305 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20306 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20307 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20308 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020309 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020310 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20311 occurs.
20312
20313 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20314 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20315 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20316 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20317 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20318 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20319 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20320 cookies" below for more details.
20321
20322 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20323 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20324 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20325 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20326 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20327 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20328 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20329 and cookies" below for more details.
20330
20331 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20332 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20333 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20334 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20335 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20336 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20337 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20338 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20339
20340
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200203418.2.4. Custom log format
20342------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020343
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020344The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020345mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020346
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020347HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020348Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20349separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20350prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20351
20352Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20353variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020354("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020355
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020356If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020357as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020358less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20359the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20360
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020361Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20362"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20363delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20364preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020365
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020366Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20367'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20368https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20369such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20370
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020371Flags are :
20372 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020373 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020374 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20375 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020376
20377 Example:
20378
20379 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20380 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20381
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020382 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20383
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020384At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20385
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020386 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20387 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020388
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020389the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020390
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020391 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20392 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20393 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020394
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020395and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20396
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020397 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20398 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020399
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020400Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20401
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020402 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020403 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020404 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20405 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20406 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020407 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20408 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20409 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020410 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020411 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020412 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020413 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020414 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020415 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20416 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020417 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020418 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020419 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020420 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020421 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020422 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020423 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020424 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20425 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20426 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20427 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20428 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020429 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020430 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020431 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020432 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020433 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020434 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20435 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020436 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20437 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20438 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020439 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020440 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20441 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020442 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020443 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20444 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20445 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020446 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020447 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020448 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20449 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20450 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20451 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020452 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020453 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020454 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020455 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020456 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020457 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020458 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20459 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20460 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020461 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020462 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20463 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020464 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020465 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20466 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020467 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020468 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020469 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020470 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020471
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020472 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020473
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020474
204758.2.5. Error log format
20476-----------------------
20477
20478When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20479protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20480By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20481"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020482will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020483logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20484
20485The format looks like this :
20486
20487 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20488 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20489 Connection error during SSL handshake
20490
20491 Field Format Extract from the example above
20492 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20493 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20494 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20495 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20496 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20497
20498These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20499failures.
20500
20501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205028.3. Advanced logging options
20503-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020504
20505Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20506just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20507options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20508for more information about their usage.
20509
20510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205118.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20512------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513
20514It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20515haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20516commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20517monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20518ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20519
20520 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20521 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20522 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20523 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20524
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020525 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20526 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020527
20528 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20529 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20530 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20531
20532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20534----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020535
20536The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20537what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20538or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020539"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020540just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20541log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20542after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20543is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20544with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20545with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20546
20547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20549------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020550
20551Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20552for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20553"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20554retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20555raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20556a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20557file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20558you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20559"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20560
20561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20563--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020564
20565Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20566multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20567them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20568"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20569logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20570error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20571and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20572too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20573useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20574alternative.
20575
20576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205778.4. Timing events
20578------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020579
20580Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20581reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20582the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20583frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020584mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20585addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20586
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020587Timings events in HTTP mode:
20588
20589 first request 2nd request
20590 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20591 t tr t tr ...
20592 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20593 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20594 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20595 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020596 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020597 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20598
20599Timings events in TCP mode:
20600
20601 TCP session
20602 |<----------------->|
20603 t t
20604 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20605 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20606 |<------ Tt ------->|
20607
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020608 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020609 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020610 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20611 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20612 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020613 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020614 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20615 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20616 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20617 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020618
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020619 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20620 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20621 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020622 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20623 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20624 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20625 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20626 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20627 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020628
20629 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20630 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20631 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20632 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20633 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20634 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20635 request typed by hand during a test.
20636
20637 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20638 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020639 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020640 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20641 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20642 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20643 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020644
20645 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20646 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20647 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20648 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20649 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20650
20651 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20652 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20653 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20654 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20655 connection never established.
20656
20657 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20658 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20659 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20660 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20661 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20662 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20663 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20664 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20665 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20666 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20667 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020669 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20670 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20671 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20672 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20673 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20674 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20675
20676 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20677
20678 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20679 "Ta" can never be negative.
20680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020681 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20682 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020683 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20684 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020685 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020687 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020688
20689 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020690 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20691 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020693 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20694 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20695 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20696 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20697 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20698 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20699 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20700 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20701
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020702These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20703protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20704that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020705due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20706"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20707that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020708
20709Most common cases :
20710
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020711 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20712 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20713 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20714 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20715 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20716 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20717 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20718 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20719 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20720 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20721 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020722 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723
20724 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20725 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20726 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20727 of ms on remote networks.
20728
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020729 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20730 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20731 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020732
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020733 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20734 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20735 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20736 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20737 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20738 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20739 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20740 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20741 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
20743Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20744
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020745 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020746 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020747 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020749 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020750 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20751 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020753 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020754 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20755 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20756 flags.
20757
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020758 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20759 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020760 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20761 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20762 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20763 the client connection was maintained open.
20764
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020765 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020766 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020767 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020768 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20769
20770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207718.5. Session state at disconnection
20772-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020773
20774TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20775"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
207762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20777each of which has a special meaning :
20778
20779 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20780 session to terminate :
20781
20782 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20783
20784 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20785 server explicitly refused it.
20786
20787 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20788 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20789 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20790 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020791 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020792
20793 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20794 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020795
20796 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20797 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20798 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20799 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20800 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20801
20802 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20803 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20804 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20805 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20806 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20807
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020808 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20809 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20810
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020811 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20812 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20813 backup connections when going up.
20814
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020815 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20816
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020817 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20818 send or receive data.
20819
20820 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20821 send or receive data.
20822
20823 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20824 with nothing left in the buffers.
20825
20826 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20827
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020828 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20830
20831 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20832 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20833 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20834 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20835 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20836
20837 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20838 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20839
20840 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20841 server (HTTP only).
20842
20843 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20844
20845 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20846 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20847 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20848
20849 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20850 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20851 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20852
20853 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20854
20855 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20856 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20857
20858 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20859 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20860 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20861
20862 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20863 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020864 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20865 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020866
20867 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20868 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20869 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20870 another server.
20871
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020872 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020873 server.
20874
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020875 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20876 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20877 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20878 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20879
20880 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20881 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20882 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20883 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20884
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020885 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20886 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20887 "use-server" rule).
20888
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020889 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20890
20891 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20892 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20893
20894 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20895
20896 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20897 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20898 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20899
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020900 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20901 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020902 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020903 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20904 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20905
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020906 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20907
20908 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20909 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20910
20911 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20912
20913 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20914
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020915The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20916was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020917helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20918starvation, attacks, etc...
20919
20920The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20921alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20922easier finding and understanding.
20923
20924 Flags Reason
20925
20926 -- Normal termination.
20927
20928 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20929 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20930 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20931 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20932
20933 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20934 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20935 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20936 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20937 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20938 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20941 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020942 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020943
20944 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20945 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20946 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20947
20948 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20949 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20950 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20951 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20952 the server takes too long to respond.
20953
20954 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20955 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20956 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20957 long a time to respond.
20958
20959 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20960 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20961 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20962 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020963 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20964 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965
20966 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20967 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20968 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20969 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20970 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020971 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020972 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20973 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20974 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20975 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20976 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20977 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20978 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20979 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020980 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020981 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20982 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20983 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020984
20985 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20986 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020987 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20988 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20989 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20990 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020991
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020992 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20993 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020995 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020996 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20997 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020998 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21000 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21001
21002 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21003 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21004 503 or 504 here.
21005
21006 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21007 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21008 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21009 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21010 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21011
21012 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21013 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021014 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021015 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21016 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21017
21018 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21019 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21020 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21021 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21022 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21023 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21024 between haproxy and the server.
21025
21026 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21027 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21028 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21029 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21030 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21031 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21032 solution is to fix the application.
21033
21034 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21035 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21036 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21037 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21038 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21039 external attacks.
21040
21041 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021042 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021043 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021044 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21045 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21046
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021047 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21048 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21049 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021050 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021051 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021053 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21054 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21055 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21056 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021057 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21058 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21059 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21060 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21061 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021062
21063 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21064 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21065 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21066 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21067
21068 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21069 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21070 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21071 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21072
21073 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21074 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21075 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21076 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21077
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021078The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21079persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21080important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21081re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21082
21083 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21084
21085 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21086 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21087 set on a GET request.
21088
21089 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21090 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021091 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021092 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21093
21094 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21095 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21096 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21097
21098 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21099 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21100 already got a cookie.
21101
21102 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21103 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21104 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21105 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21106 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21107
21108 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21109 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21110 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21111
21112 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21113 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21114 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21115
21116 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21117 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21118
21119 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21120 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21121 then advertised in the response.
21122
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211248.6. Non-printable characters
21125-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126
21127In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21128consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21129converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21130prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21131being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21132escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21133is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21134'}' when logging headers.
21135
21136Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21137issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21138containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21139
21140Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21141the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21142performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21143
21144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21146---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021147
21148Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21149achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021150section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021151cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21152the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21153the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021154locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21156user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21157a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21158wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21159
21160 Examples :
21161 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21162 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21163
21164 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21165 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21166
21167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21169---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021170
21171Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21172proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21173the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21174server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21175
21176Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21177response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021178section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179
21180It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021181time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21182appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021183are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21184and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21185follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21186request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21187in the logs.
21188
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021189As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21190frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21191an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193 Example :
21194 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21195 listen proxy-out
21196 mode http
21197 option httplog
21198 option logasap
21199 log global
21200 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21201
21202 # log the name of the virtual server
21203 capture request header Host len 20
21204
21205 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21206 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21207
21208 # log the beginning of the referrer
21209 capture request header Referer len 20
21210
21211 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21212 capture response header Server len 20
21213
21214 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21215 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21216
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021217 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021218 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21219
21220 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21221 capture response header Via len 20
21222
21223 # log the URL location during a redirection
21224 capture response header Location len 20
21225
21226 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21227 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21228 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21229 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21230 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21231
21232 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21233 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21234 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21235 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021236 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237
21238 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21239 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21240 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21241 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21242 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021243 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021244
21245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212468.9. Examples of logs
21247---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021248
21249These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21250them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21251reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21252
21253 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21254 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21255 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21256
21257 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21258 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21259
21260 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21261 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21262 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21263
21264 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21265 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21266
21267 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21268 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21269 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21270
21271 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021272 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021273 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21274 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21275
21276 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21277 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21278 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21279
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021280 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21281 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21282 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21283 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21284 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21285 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021286
21287 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021288 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021289
21290 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21291 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21292 Nothing was sent to any server.
21293
21294 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21295 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21296
21297 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21298 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021299 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021300 send a 408 return code to the client.
21301
21302 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21303 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21304
21305 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21306 5 seconds ("c----").
21307
21308 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21309 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021310 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021311
21312 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021313 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021314 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21315 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21316 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21317 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21318 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021319
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021320
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200213219. Supported filters
21322--------------------
21323
21324Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21325accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21326unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21327
21328See also : "filter"
21329
213309.1. Trace
21331----------
21332
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021333filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021334
21335 Arguments:
21336 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21337 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21338
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021339 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021341 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021342 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21343 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21344 amount of the parsed data.
21345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021346 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021347
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021348This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21349callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21350information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21351filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21352
21353Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21354tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21355a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21356
21357
213589.2. HTTP compression
21359---------------------
21360
21361filter compression
21362
21363The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21364keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021365when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21366fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21367done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21368explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21369filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21370listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21371order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021372
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021373See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21374 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021375
21376
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200213779.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21378--------------------------------------------
21379
21380filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21381
21382 Arguments :
21383
21384 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21385 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21386 parsed.
21387
21388 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21389 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21390 part must be placed in its own scope.
21391
21392The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21393external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021394streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021395exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21396also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21397
21398SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21399the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21400
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021401For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021402"doc/SPOE.txt".
21403
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214049.4. Cache
21405----------
21406
21407filter cache <name>
21408
21409 Arguments :
21410
21411 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21412
21413The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21414"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021415cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021416other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21417case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21418is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21419filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021420listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21421order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021422
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021423See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21424 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21425
21426
214279.5. Fcgi-app
21428-------------
21429
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021430filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021431
21432 Arguments :
21433
21434 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21435
21436The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21437request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21438reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21439used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21440implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21441used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21442fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21443used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21444order.
21445
21446See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21447 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21448
21449
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100214509.6. OpenTracing
21451----------------
21452
21453The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21454HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21455of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21456Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21457
21458This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21459
21460The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21461HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21462participates in the work of HAProxy.
21463
21464filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21465
21466 Arguments :
21467
21468 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21469 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21470 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21471 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21472 OpenTracing filters.
21473
21474 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21475 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21476 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21477 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21478 filter must have its own scope defined.
21479
21480More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021481of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021482
21483
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002148410. FastCGI applications
21485-------------------------
21486
21487HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21488feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21489the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21490FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21491servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21492FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21493backend.
21494
21495HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21496application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21497connection.
21498
2149910.1. Setup
21500-----------
21501
2150210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21503--------------------------
21504
21505fcgi-app <name>
21506 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21507 document root must be defined.
21508
21509acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21510 Declare or complete an access list.
21511
21512 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21513 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21514 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21515 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21516 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21517
21518docroot <path>
21519 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21520 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21521 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21522
21523index <script-name>
21524 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21525 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21526 is an optional setting.
21527
21528 Example :
21529 index index.php
21530
21531log-stderr global
21532log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021533 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021534 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21535
21536 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21537 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21538
21539pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21540 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21541 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21542 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21543
21544 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21545 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21546 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21547 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21548
21549 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21550 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21551
21552path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021553 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021554 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21555 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21556 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21557 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21558 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21559 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21560 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021561
21562 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021563 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021564 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21565 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21566 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21567 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021568
21569 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021570 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21571 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021572
21573option get-values
21574no option get-values
21575 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21576
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021577 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021578 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21579
21580 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21581 application will accept.
21582
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021583 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21584 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021585
21586 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021587 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021588 option is disabled.
21589
21590 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21591 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21592 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21593 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21594 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21595 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21596
21597option keep-conn
21598no option keep-conn
21599 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21600 sending a response.
21601
21602 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21603 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21604
21605option max-reqs <reqs>
21606 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21607 accept.
21608
21609 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21610 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21611 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21612 to 1.
21613
21614option mpxs-conns
21615no option mpxs-conns
21616 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21617
21618 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21619 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21620
21621set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21622 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21623 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21624 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21625 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21626
21627 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21628 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21629 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21630
21631 Example :
21632 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21633 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21634
21635 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21636
21637
2163810.1.2. Proxy section
21639---------------------
21640
21641use-fcgi-app <name>
21642 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21643
21644 Arguments :
21645 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21646
21647 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21648 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21649 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21650 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21651 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21652
21653 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21654 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21655 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21656 application are evaluated.
21657
21658
2165910.1.3. Example
21660---------------
21661
21662 frontend front-http
21663 mode http
21664 bind *:80
21665 bind *:
21666
21667 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21668 default_backend back-static
21669
21670 backend back-static
21671 mode http
21672 server www A.B.C.D:80
21673
21674 backend back-dynamic
21675 mode http
21676 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21677 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21678
21679 fcgi-app php-fpm
21680 log-stderr global
21681 option keep-conn
21682
21683 docroot /var/www/my-app
21684 index index.php
21685 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21686
21687
2168810.2. Default parameters
21689------------------------
21690
21691A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21692the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021693script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021694applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21695
21696 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21697 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21698 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21699 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21700 | | |
21701 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21702 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21703 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21704 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21705 | | application. |
21706 | | |
21707 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21708 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21709 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21710 | | |
21711 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21712 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21713 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21714 | | the application's configuration. |
21715 | | |
21716 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21717 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21718 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21719 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21720 | | |
21721 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21722 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21723 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21724 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21725 | | be defined. |
21726 | | |
21727 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21728 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21729 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21730 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21731 | | is not set too. |
21732 | | |
21733 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21734 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21735 | | set. |
21736 | | |
21737 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21738 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21739 | | the request. |
21740 | | |
21741 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21742 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21743 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21744 | | |
21745 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21746 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21747 | | script to process the request. |
21748 | | |
21749 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21750 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21751 | | |
21752 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21753 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21754 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21755 | | |
21756 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21757 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21758 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21759 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21760 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21761 | | |
21762 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21763 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21764 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21765 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21766 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21767 | | side. |
21768 | | |
21769 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21770 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21771 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21772 | | connected to. |
21773 | | |
21774 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21775 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21776 | | |
21777 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21778 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21779 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21780 | | |
21781 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21782
21783
2178410.3. Limitations
21785------------------
21786
21787The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21788way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21789during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21790establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21791application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21792or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21793message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21794these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21795and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21796
21797Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21798request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21799requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21800
21801About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21802into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21803fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21804"http-request" ones.
21805
21806Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21807FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21808processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21809must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21810here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021811
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021812
2181311. Address formats
21814-------------------
21815
21816Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21817address.
21818
21819This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21820The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21821of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21822equivalent is '::'.
21823
21824Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21825is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21826
21827This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21828family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21829
21830Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21831configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21832use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21833'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21834
21835Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21836socket type and the transport method.
21837
21838
2183911.1 Address family prefixes
21840----------------------------
21841
21842'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21843
21844'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21845 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21846 listening.
21847
21848'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21849 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21850 on the statement using this address, a port or
21851 a port range may or must be specified.
21852
21853'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21854 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21855 using this address, a port or a port range
21856 may or must be specified.
21857
21858'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21859 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21860 using this address, a port or a port range
21861 may or must be specified.
21862
21863'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21864 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21865 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21866 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21867 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21868 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21869
21870'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21871 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21872 start by slash '/'.
21873
21874
2187511.2 Socket type prefixes
21876-------------------------
21877
21878Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21879type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21880this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21881This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21882but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21883
21884Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21885instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21886
21887If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21888they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21889report this to the maintainers.
21890
21891'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21892 to "stream"
21893
21894'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21895 to "datagram".
21896
21897
2189811.3 Protocol prefixes
21899----------------------
21900
21901'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21902 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21903 socket type and transport method is forced to
21904 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21905 this address, a port or a port range can or
21906 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21907 of 'stream+ip@'.
21908
21909'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21910 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21911 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21912 statement using this address, a port or port
21913 range can or must be specified.
21914 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21915
21916'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21917 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21918 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21919 statement using this address, a port or port
21920 range can or must be specified.
21921 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21922
21923'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21924 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21925 socket type and transport method is forced to
21926 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21927 this address, a port or a port range can or
21928 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21929 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21930
21931'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21932 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21933 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21934 the statement using this address, a port or
21935 port range can or must be specified.
21936 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21937
21938'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21939 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21940 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21941 the statement using this address, a port or
21942 port range can or must be specified.
21943 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21944
21945'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21946 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21947 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21948
21949'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21950 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21951 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21952
21953In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21954QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021956/*
21957 * Local variables:
21958 * fill-column: 79
21959 * End:
21960 */